drivers/linuxgpiod: Migrate to adapter gpio commands
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
34 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
35 Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
83 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
84 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
85 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
86 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
87
88 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
89 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
90 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
91 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
92 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
93 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
94 @end menu
95
96 @node About
97 @unnumbered About
98 @cindex about
99
100 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
101 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
102 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
103 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
104 around the world.
105
106 @section What is OpenOCD?
107 @cindex TAP
108 @cindex JTAG
109
110 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
111 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
112 devices.
113
114 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
115 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
116 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
117 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
118 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
119 needed to hook up to the target.
120
121 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
122 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
123 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
124 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
125 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
126
127 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
128 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
129 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
130 let the development board connect directly to the debug
131 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
132
133 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
134 signaling, and is used to communicate
135 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
136 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
137 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
138 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
139 scan operations.
140
141 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
142 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
143 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
144 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
145
146 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
147 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
148 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
149 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
150
151
152 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
153 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
154 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
155
156 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
157 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
158 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
159 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
160
161 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
162 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
163 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
164 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
165 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
166
167 @section OpenOCD Web Site
168
169 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
170
171 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
172
173 @section Latest User's Guide:
174
175 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
176 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
177 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
178
179 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
180
181 PDF form is likewise published at:
182
183 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
184
185 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
186
187 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
188 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
189 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
190 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
191 instead of this forum.
192
193 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
194
195 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
196
197 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
198 communication between users:
199
200 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
201
202 @section OpenOCD IRC
203
204 Support can also be found on irc:
205 @uref{irc://irc.libera.chat/openocd}
206
207 @node Developers
208 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
209 @cindex developers
210
211 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
212 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
213 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
214 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
215
216 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
217 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
218
219 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
220
221 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
222 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
223
224 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
225
226 or via http
227
228 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
229
230 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
231
232 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
233
234 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
235 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
236 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
237 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
238 needing a Git client:
239
240 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
241
242 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
243 from the repository or a snapshot.
244
245 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
246 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
247 Patches created against older versions may require additional
248 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
249
250 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
251
252 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
253 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
254 technical information about the software internals, development
255 processes, and similar documentation:
256
257 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
258
259 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
260 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
261 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
262
263 @section Gerrit Review System
264
265 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
266 Code Review System:
267
268 @uref{https://review.openocd.org/}
269
270 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
271 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
272 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
273 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
274 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
275
276 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
277 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
278 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
279 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
280 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
281
282 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
283
284 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
285 communication between developers:
286
287 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
288
289 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
290
291 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
292
293 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
294
295
296 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
297 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @cindex dongles
299 @cindex FTDI
300 @cindex wiggler
301 @cindex printer port
302 @cindex USB Adapter
303 @cindex RTCK
304
305 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
306 an adapter .... [snip]
307
308 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
309 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port.
310
311
312 @section Choosing a Dongle
313
314 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
315
316 @enumerate
317 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
318 OpenOCD focuses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
319 other ways to communicate with target devices.
320 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
321 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
322 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
323 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
324 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
325 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
326 Ethernet port needed?
327 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
328 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
329 @end enumerate
330
331 @section USB FT2232 Based
332
333 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
334 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
335 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
336 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
337 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
338 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
339 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
340 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
341 clocking.)
342
343 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
344 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
345 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
346 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
347 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
348
349 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
350 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
351
352 @itemize @bullet
353 @item @b{usbjtag}
354 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
355 @item @b{jtagkey}
356 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
357 @item @b{jtagkey2}
358 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
359 @item @b{oocdlink}
360 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
361 @item @b{signalyzer}
362 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
363 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
364 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
365 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
366 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
367 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
368 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
369 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
370 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
371 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
372 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
373 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
374 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
375 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
376 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
377 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
378 @item @b{turtelizer2}
379 @* See:
380 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
381 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
382 @item @b{comstick}
383 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
384 @item @b{stm32stick}
385 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
386 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
387 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
388 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
389 @item @b{cortino}
390 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
391 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
392 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
393 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
394 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
395 @item @b{opendous}
396 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
397 (OpenHardware).
398 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
399 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
400
401 @item @b{GW16042}
402 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
403 FT2232H-based
404
405 @end itemize
406 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
407
408 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
409 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
410 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
411 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
412 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
413
414 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
415 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
416 (see the section on driver commands).
417
418 @itemize
419 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
420 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
421 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
422 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
423 @end itemize
424
425 @section USB J-Link based
426 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
427 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
428 AT91SAM764 internally.
429
430 @itemize @bullet
431 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
432 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
433 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
434 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
435 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
436 @end itemize
437
438 @section USB RLINK based
439 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
440 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
441 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
442
443 @itemize @bullet
444 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
445 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
446 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
447 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
448 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB ST-LINK based
453 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
454 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
455
456 @itemize @bullet
457 @item @b{ST-LINK}
458 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
460 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
461 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
462 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
463 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
464 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
465 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
466 @end itemize
467
468 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
469 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
470 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
471 @itemize @bullet
472 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
473 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
474 @end itemize
475
476 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
477 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
478 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
479 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
480
481 @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
482 Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
483 It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
484 It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
485 Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
486
487 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
488 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
489 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
490
491 @section USB Other
492 @itemize @bullet
493 @item @b{USBprog}
494 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
495
496 @item @b{USB - Presto}
497 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
498
499 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
500 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
501
502 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
503 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
504
505 @item @b{Buspirate}
506 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
507
508 @item @b{opendous}
509 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
510
511 @item @b{estick}
512 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
513
514 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
515 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
516
517 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
518 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
519 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
520 @end itemize
521
522 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
523
524 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
525 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
526 these on the market.
527
528 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
529 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
530 of USB-based ones.
531
532 @itemize @bullet
533
534 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
535 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
536
537 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
538 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
539 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
540
541 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
542 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
543
544 @item @b{Wiggler2}
545 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
546
547 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
548 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
549
550 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
551 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
552
553 @item @b{arm-jtag}
554 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
555
556 @item @b{chameleon}
557 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
558
559 @item @b{Triton}
560 @* Unknown.
561
562 @item @b{Lattice}
563 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
564 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
565
566 @item @b{flashlink}
567 @* From STMicroelectronics;
568 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
569
570 @end itemize
571
572 @section Other...
573 @itemize @bullet
574
575 @item @b{ep93xx}
576 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
577
578 @item @b{at91rm9200}
579 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
580
581 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
582 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
583
584 @item @b{imx_gpio}
585 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
586
587 @item @b{am335xgpio}
588 @* A Texas Instruments AM335x-based board (e.g. BeagleBone Black) using the GPIO pins of the expansion headers.
589
590 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
591 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
592 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
593
594 @item @b{vdebug}
595 @* A driver for Cadence virtual Debug Interface to emulated or simulated targets.
596 It implements a client connecting to the vdebug server, which in turn communicates
597 with the emulated or simulated RTL model through a transactor. The driver supports
598 JTAG and DAP-level transports.
599
600 @item @b{jtag_dpi}
601 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
602 Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
603 interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
604 emulation model of target hardware.
605
606 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
607 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
608
609 @item @b{linuxgpiod}
610 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux GPIO through library libgpiod.
611
612 @item @b{sysfsgpio}
613 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux legacy sysfs GPIO.
614 This is deprecated from Linux v5.3; prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}.
615
616 @item @b{esp_usb_jtag}
617 @* A JTAG driver to communicate with builtin debug modules of Espressif ESP32-C3 and ESP32-S3 chips using OpenOCD.
618
619 @end itemize
620
621 @node About Jim-Tcl
622 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
623 @cindex Jim-Tcl
624 @cindex tcl
625
626 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
627 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
628 command interpreter.
629
630 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
631 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
632 much of anything about Tcl.
633 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
634
635 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
636 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
637 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
638 OpenOCD mailing list.
639
640 @itemize @bullet
641 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
642 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
643 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
644 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
645 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
646 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
647
648 @item @b{Missing Features}
649 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
650 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
651 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
652 enabled in OpenOCD.
653
654 @item @b{Scripts}
655 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
656 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
657 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
658
659 @item @b{Commands}
660 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
661 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
662 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
663 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
664
665 @item @b{Historical Note}
666 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
667 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
668 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
669 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
670
671 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
672 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
673 @end itemize
674
675 @node Running
676 @chapter Running
677 @cindex command line options
678 @cindex logfile
679 @cindex directory search
680
681 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
682 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
683 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
684 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
685 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
686 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
687 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
688
689 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
690 tell it how each debug session should work.
691 The @option{--help} option shows:
692 @verbatim
693 bash$ openocd --help
694
695 --help | -h display this help
696 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
697 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
698 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
699 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
700 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
701 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
702 --command | -c run <command>
703 @end verbatim
704
705 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
706 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
707 To specify one or more different
708 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
709
710 @example
711 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
712 @end example
713
714 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
715 @enumerate
716 @item the current directory,
717 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
718 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
719 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
720 @item @file{%APPDATA%/OpenOCD} (only on Windows),
721 @item @file{$HOME/Library/Preferences/org.openocd} (only on Darwin),
722 @item @file{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/openocd} (@env{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME} defaults to @file{$HOME/.config}),
723 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd},
724 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
725 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
726 @end enumerate
727 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
728
729 @quotation Note
730 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
731 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
732 @end quotation
733
734 @section Simple setup, no customization
735
736 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
737 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
738 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
739 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
740 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
741
742 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
743 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
744 the server with some variation of one of the following:
745
746 @example
747 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
748 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
749 @end example
750
751 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
752 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
753 If all goes well you'll see output something like
754
755 @example
756 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
757 For bug reports, read
758 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
759 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
760 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
761 @end example
762
763 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
764 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
765 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
766
767 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
768
769 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
770 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
771 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
772 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
773 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
774 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
775 ensure that this always succeeds.
776 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
777 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
778 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
779 and then shut down without acting as a server.
780
781 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
782 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
783 those channels.
784
785 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
786 the @option{-d} option.
787
788 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
789 @option{-c} command line switch.
790
791 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
792 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
793 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
794 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
795 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
796 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
797 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
798
799 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
800 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
801
802 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
803 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
804 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
805 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
806
807 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
808 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
809
810 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
811 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
812 and start the OpenOCD server.
813 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
814 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
815 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
816 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
817
818 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
819
820 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
821 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
822 and a USB cable on the other.
823 Instead of USB, some dongles use Ethernet;
824 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
825
826 @enumerate
827 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
828 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
829 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
830 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
831 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
832 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
833 debugging host.
834
835 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
836 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
837 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
838 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
839 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
840
841 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
842 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
843 with 1.2 Volt boards.
844
845 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
846 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
847 ways to connect the cable.
848 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
849 Be sure it's firmly connected.
850
851 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
852 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
853 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
854 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
855 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
856 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
857 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
858 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
859
860 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
861 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
862 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
863 but are tedious to set up.
864 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
865 adapter signals to the right board pins.
866
867 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
868 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
869 you are using to run OpenOCD.
870 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
871
872 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
873 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
874 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
875 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
876
877 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
878 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
879 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
880
881 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
882 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
883 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
884 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
885
886 @end enumerate
887
888 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
889 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
890 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
891
892 @section Project Directory
893
894 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
895
896 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
897 single directory for your work with a given board.
898 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
899 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
900 files accessed through semihosting,
901 and for code you upload to the target board.
902 It is also the natural place to write files,
903 such as log files and data you download from the board.
904
905 @section Configuration Basics
906
907 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
908 a variety of ways you can mix them.
909 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
910
911 @itemize
912 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
913 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
914 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
915 @end itemize
916
917 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
918 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
919 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
920
921 @example
922 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
923
924 # GDB can also flash my flash!
925 gdb_memory_map enable
926 gdb_flash_program enable
927
928 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
929 @end example
930
931 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
932
933 @example
934 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
935 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
936 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
937 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
938 @end example
939
940 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
941 each supporting a different development task.
942 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
943 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
944
945 @quotation Important
946 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
947 problems with how it treats variables.
948 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
949 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
950 that can be tested in a later script.
951 @end quotation
952
953 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
954 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
955 to simplify your work.
956
957 @section User Config Files
958 @cindex config file, user
959 @cindex user config file
960 @cindex config file, overview
961
962 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
963 in one place.
964 One of the following will match your situation best:
965
966 @itemize
967 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
968 provided by someone else.
969 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
970 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
971 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
972 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
973 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
974 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
975
976 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
977 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
978
979 @enumerate
980 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
981 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
982 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
983 @end enumerate
984
985 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
986 The first is an interface config file.
987 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
988 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
989 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
990 meet your deadline:
991
992 @example
993 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
994 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
995 @end example
996
997 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
998 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
999 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
1000 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
1001
1002 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
1003 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
1004 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
1005 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
1006 target and board
1007 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
1008 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
1009
1010 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
1011 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1012 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1013 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1014
1015 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1016 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1017 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1018 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1019 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1020
1021 @quotation Note
1022 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1023 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1024 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1025 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1026 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1027 @end quotation
1028
1029 @item
1030 You may need to write some C code.
1031 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1032 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1033 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1034 a new chip architecture.
1035 @end itemize
1036
1037 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1038 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1039 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1040
1041 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1042 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1043 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1044 @itemize
1045
1046 @item
1047 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1048 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1049 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1050 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1051
1052 @item
1053 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1054 @cindex vector_catch
1055 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1056 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1057 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1058 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1059 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1060 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1061
1062 @item
1063 You might need to override some defaults.
1064 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1065 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1066
1067 @item
1068 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1069 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1070 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1071 @end itemize
1072
1073 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1074
1075 A few project-specific utility
1076 routines may well speed up your work.
1077 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1078
1079 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1080 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1081 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1082 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1083 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1084 may help:
1085
1086 @example
1087 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1088 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1089 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1090 # Leave the CPU halted.
1091 reset init
1092
1093 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1094 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1095
1096 # Start running.
1097 resume 0x20000000
1098 @}
1099 @end example
1100
1101 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1102 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1103 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1104 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1105 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1106
1107 @example
1108 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1109 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1110 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1111 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1112 reset init
1113
1114 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1115 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1116 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1117 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1118 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1119 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1120 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1121
1122 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1123 reset run
1124 @}
1125 @end example
1126
1127 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1128 from NAND.
1129 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1130 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1131 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1132
1133 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1134 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1135
1136 @section Target Software Changes
1137
1138 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1139 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1140 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1141 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1142 handling issues like:
1143
1144 @itemize @bullet
1145
1146 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1147 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1148 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1149 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1150 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1151 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1152 your debug sessions.
1153
1154 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1155 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1156 That might however be your only option.
1157
1158 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1159 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1160 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1161 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1162 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1163 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1164 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1165 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1166 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1167 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1168 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1169 instead of the whole thing.
1170 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1171 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1172
1173 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1174 @cindex ARM semihosting
1175 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1176 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1177 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1178 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1179 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1180 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1181 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1182 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1183 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1184 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1185 NAND or SPI flash.
1186
1187 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1188 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1189 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1190 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1191 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1192
1193 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1194 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1195 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1196 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1197 registers which can be used to change various features including
1198 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1199 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1200 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1201 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1202 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1203
1204 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1205 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1206 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1207 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1208 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1209
1210 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1211 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1212 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1213 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1214 early code execution can be debugged
1215 or firmware can be replaced.
1216
1217 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1218 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1219 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1220 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1221 operations like writing to memory.)
1222
1223 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1224 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1225 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1226 various kinds of message.
1227 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1228
1229 @end itemize
1230
1231 @section Target Hardware Setup
1232
1233 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1234 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1235 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1236 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1237 working with.}
1238
1239 Common issues include:
1240
1241 @itemize @bullet
1242
1243 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1244 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1245 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1246 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1247 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1248 or one from a daughtercard).
1249 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1250 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1251
1252 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1253 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1254 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1255 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1256 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1257 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1258
1259 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1260 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1261 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1262 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1263 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1264
1265
1266 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1267 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1268 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1269 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1270 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1271 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1272 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1273
1274 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1275 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1276 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1277 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1278 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1279
1280 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1281 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1282 used to start booting.
1283
1284 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1285 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1286 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1287 multiple audio codec chips).
1288 This interacts with software
1289 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1290 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1291 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1292 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1293 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1294 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1295 audio or video codecs are used.
1296
1297 @end itemize
1298
1299 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1300 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1301 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1302 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1303 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1304 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1305 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1306 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1307 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1308 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1309
1310
1311 @node Config File Guidelines
1312 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1313
1314 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1315 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1316 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1317 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1318
1319 You should find the following directories under
1320 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1321 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1322 @itemize @bullet
1323 @item @file{interface} ...
1324 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1325 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1326 @item @file{board} ...
1327 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1328 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1329
1330 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1331 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1332 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1333 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1334 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1335 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1336 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1337 a CPU and an FPGA.
1338 @item @file{target} ...
1339 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1340 on a chip
1341 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1342 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1343 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1344 the target config file defines all of them.
1345 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1346 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1347 @end itemize
1348
1349 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1350 file may override features in any of the above files by
1351 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1352 commands specific to their situation.
1353
1354 @section Interface Config Files
1355
1356 The user config file
1357 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1358
1359 @example
1360 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1361 @end example
1362
1363 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1364 in use today with OpenOCD.
1365 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1366 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1367
1368 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1369 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1370 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1371 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1372 and need to provide a driver for it.
1373
1374 @deffn {Command} {find} 'filename'
1375 Prints full path to @var{filename} according to OpenOCD search rules.
1376 @end deffn
1377
1378 @deffn {Command} {ocd_find} 'filename'
1379 Prints full path to @var{filename} according to OpenOCD search rules. This
1380 is a low level function used by the @command{find}. Usually you want
1381 to use @command{find}, instead.
1382 @end deffn
1383
1384 @section Board Config Files
1385 @cindex config file, board
1386 @cindex board config file
1387
1388 The user config file
1389 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1390
1391 @example
1392 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1393 @end example
1394
1395 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1396 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1397 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1398
1399 @enumerate
1400 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1401 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1402 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1403 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1404 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1405 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1406 @end enumerate
1407
1408 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1409 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1410 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1411 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1412
1413 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1414 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1415 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1416 configuration works.
1417
1418 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1419
1420 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1421 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1422 convention on how to use certain variables.
1423
1424 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1425 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1426 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1427 used at will within a target configuration file.
1428
1429 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1430 for a board with three chips:
1431
1432 @example
1433 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1434 set CHIPNAME network
1435 set ENDIAN big
1436 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1437 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1438 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1439 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1440
1441 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1442 set CHIPNAME video
1443 set ENDIAN little
1444 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1445 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1446 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1447 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1448
1449 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1450 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1451 unset ENDIAN
1452 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1453 @end example
1454
1455 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1456 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1457 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1458 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1459 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1460 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1461 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1462 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1463
1464 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1465 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1466 naming collisions.
1467
1468 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1469 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1470 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1471 up other clocks and peripherals.
1472
1473 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1474 @cindex variable names
1475
1476 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1477 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1478 one such chip (as shown above).
1479 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1480 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1481 to promote consistency and
1482 so that board files can override target defaults.
1483
1484 Inputs to target config files include:
1485
1486 @itemize @bullet
1487 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1488 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1489 tap identifier dotted names.
1490 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1491 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1492 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1493 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1494 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1495 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1496 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1497 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1498 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1499 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1500 @end itemize
1501
1502 Outputs from target config files include:
1503
1504 @itemize @bullet
1505 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1506 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1507 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1508 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1509 specific to that board and that target.
1510 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1511 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1512 @end itemize
1513
1514 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1515 @cindex event, reset-init
1516 @cindex reset-init handler
1517
1518 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1519 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1520 fully set up yet.
1521 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1522 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1523 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1524 handler is one of the most important.
1525
1526 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1527 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1528 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1529 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1530 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1531
1532 @quotation Note
1533 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1534 are included here.
1535 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1536 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1537 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1538 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1539 @end quotation
1540
1541 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1542 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1543 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1544 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1545 those as parameters.
1546 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1547 and disabling the watchdog.
1548 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1549 the next developer doing such work.
1550 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1551
1552 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1553 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1554 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1555 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1556
1557 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1558
1559 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1560 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1561 a low JTAG clock rate.
1562 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1563 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1564 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1565 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1566 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1567 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1568 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1569
1570 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1571 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1572 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1573 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1574 which might be less than that.
1575
1576 @quotation Warning
1577 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1578 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1579 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1580 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1581 @end quotation
1582
1583 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1584 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1585 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1586 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1587 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1588 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1589
1590 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1591 @subsection The init_board procedure
1592 @cindex init_board procedure
1593
1594 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1595 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1596 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1597 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1598 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1599 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1600 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1601 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1602 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1603 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1604 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1605 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1606
1607 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1608 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1609
1610 @example
1611 ### board_file.cfg ###
1612
1613 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1614 source [find target/target.cfg]
1615
1616 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1617 # enables fast on-board clock source
1618 # configures the chip to use it
1619 @}
1620
1621 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1622 proc init_board @{@} @{
1623 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1624
1625 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1626 adapter speed 100
1627 @}
1628
1629 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1630 enable_fast_clock
1631 adapter speed 10000
1632 @}
1633 @}
1634 @end example
1635
1636 @section Target Config Files
1637 @cindex config file, target
1638 @cindex target config file
1639
1640 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1641 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1642 more target config files like this:
1643
1644 @example
1645 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1646 @end example
1647
1648 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1649 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1650 In summary the target files should contain
1651
1652 @enumerate
1653 @item Set defaults
1654 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1655 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1656 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1657 @item On-Chip flash
1658 @end enumerate
1659
1660 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1661 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1662 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1663
1664 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1665 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1666 can talk to the chip.
1667 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1668 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1669 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1670 and other processing engines.
1671
1672 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1673
1674 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1675 letting board config files express environment-specific
1676 differences in how things should be set up.
1677
1678 @example
1679 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1680 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1681 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1682 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1683 @} else @{
1684 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1685 @}
1686
1687 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1688 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1689 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1690 @} else @{
1691 set _ENDIAN little
1692 @}
1693
1694 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1695 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1696 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1697 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1698 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1699 @} else @{
1700 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1701 @}
1702 @end example
1703 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1704
1705 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1706 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1707 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1708
1709 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1710 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1711 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1712
1713 @example
1714 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1715 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1716 @end example
1717
1718 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1719 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1720 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1721 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1722 for taps.
1723
1724 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1725 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1726 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1727 looks (in part) like this:
1728
1729 @example
1730 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1731 @end example
1732
1733 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1734 to source such a config file twice, with different
1735 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1736 it adds a different TAP each time.
1737
1738 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1739 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1740 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1741 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1742
1743 @example
1744 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1745 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1746 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1747 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1748 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1749 @end example
1750
1751 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1752 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1753
1754 @itemize
1755 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1756 plus a JRC to enable them
1757 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1758 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1759 is not currently used)
1760 @end itemize
1761
1762 @subsection Add CPU targets
1763
1764 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1765 GDB and other commands can use it.
1766 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1767 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1768 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1769 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1770
1771 @example
1772 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1773 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1774 @end example
1775
1776 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1777 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1778 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1779 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1780 a work area if you can.
1781 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1782
1783 @example
1784 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1785 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1786 @end example
1787
1788 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1789 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1790 @cindex SMP
1791 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1792
1793 @example
1794 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1795 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1796 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1797 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1798 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1799 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1800 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1801 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1802 @end example
1803 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1804 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1805 @itemize @bullet
1806 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1807 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1808 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1809 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1810 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1811 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1812 @end itemize
1813
1814 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1815 command have been implemented.
1816 @itemize @bullet
1817 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1818 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1819 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1820 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1821 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1822 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1823 following example.
1824 @end itemize
1825
1826 @example
1827 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1828 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1829 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1830 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1831 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1832 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1833 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1834 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1835 > resume
1836 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1837 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1838 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1839 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1840 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1841 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1842 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1843 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1844 @end example
1845
1846
1847 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1848
1849 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1850 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1851 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1852
1853 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1854 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1855 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1856 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1857 both signals.
1858
1859 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1860 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1861 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1862 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1863 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1864 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1865 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1866 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1867 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1868 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1869 not available.)
1870
1871 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1872 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1873 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1874 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1875 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1876 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1877 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1878 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1879
1880 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1881 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1882 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1883 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1884 slower clock than they will use later.
1885 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1886 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1887 than they will use later.
1888 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1889
1890 @quotation Important
1891 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1892 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1893 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1894 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1895 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1896 @end quotation
1897
1898 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1899 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1900 @cindex init_targets procedure
1901
1902 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1903 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1904 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1905 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1906 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1907 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1908 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1909 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1910 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1911
1912 @example
1913 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1914
1915 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1916 # basic initialization procedure ...
1917 @}
1918
1919 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1920 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1921 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1922 @}
1923
1924 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1925
1926 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1927
1928 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1929 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1930 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1931 @}
1932 @end example
1933
1934 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1935 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1936
1937 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1938
1939 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1940 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1941
1942 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1943 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1944 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1945
1946 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1947 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1948 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1949 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1950 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1951 events already assigned.
1952
1953 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1954
1955 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1956 special high speed download features - enable it.
1957
1958 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1959
1960 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1961 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1962 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1963 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1964 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1965 If you are using an external trace port,
1966 configure it in your board config file.
1967 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1968 configure it in your target config file.
1969
1970 @example
1971 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1972 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1973 @end example
1974
1975 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1976
1977 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1978
1979 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1980 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1981 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1982 the TARGET (chip) file.
1983
1984 Examples:
1985 @itemize @bullet
1986 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1987 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1988 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1989 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1990 @end itemize
1991
1992 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1993 @section Translating Configuration Files
1994 @cindex translation
1995 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1996 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1997 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1998 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1999 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
2000 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
2001
2002 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
2003 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
2004 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
2005 convert other scripts later on.
2006
2007 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
2008 replace job:
2009
2010 @example
2011 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
2012 #
2013 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
2014 #
2015 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
2016 #
2017 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
2018
2019 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
2020 global TARGETNAME
2021
2022 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2023
2024 arm mcr 15 [expr @{($regs >> 12) & 0x7@}] \
2025 [expr @{($regs >> 0) & 0xf@}] [expr @{($regs >> 4) & 0xf@}] \
2026 [expr @{($regs >> 8) & 0x7@}] $value
2027 @}
2028 @end example
2029
2030
2031
2032 @node Server Configuration
2033 @chapter Server Configuration
2034 @cindex initialization
2035 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2036 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2037 supported.
2038
2039 @anchor{configurationstage}
2040 @section Configuration Stage
2041 @cindex configuration stage
2042 @cindex config command
2043
2044 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2045 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2046 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2047 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2048 inside startup scripts.
2049
2050 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2051 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2052 which may be issued interactively.
2053 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2054 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2055
2056 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2057 flash banks,
2058 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2059 and other basic setup.
2060 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2061 may access or activate TAPs.
2062 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2063 longer be issued.
2064
2065 @deffn {Command} {command mode} [command_name]
2066 Returns the command modes allowed by a command: 'any', 'config', or
2067 'exec'. If no command is specified, returns the current command
2068 mode. Returns 'unknown' if an unknown command is given. Command can be
2069 multiple tokens. (command valid any time)
2070
2071 In this document, the modes are described as stages, 'config' and
2072 'exec' mode correspond configuration stage and run stage. 'any' means
2073 the command can be executed in either
2074 stages. @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}, and
2075 @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.
2076 @end deffn
2077
2078 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2079 @section Entering the Run Stage
2080
2081 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2082 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2083 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2084 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2085 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2086 You should see no errors at this point.
2087 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2088 commands you used to configure the server.
2089 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2090 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2091 on the scan chain.
2092
2093 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2094 become available.
2095 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2096 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2097 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2098 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2099 entry to the run stage.
2100
2101 @deffn {Config Command} {init}
2102 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2103 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2104 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2105 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2106 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2107 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2108
2109 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2110 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2111 configuration files and/or command line options.
2112
2113 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs near the end of your
2114 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2115 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2116 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2117 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2118
2119 @command{init} calls the following internal OpenOCD commands to initialize
2120 corresponding subsystems:
2121 @deffn {Config Command} {target init}
2122 @deffnx {Command} {transport init}
2123 @deffnx {Command} {dap init}
2124 @deffnx {Config Command} {flash init}
2125 @deffnx {Config Command} {nand init}
2126 @deffnx {Config Command} {pld init}
2127 @deffnx {Command} {tpiu init}
2128 @end deffn
2129
2130 At last, @command{init} executes all the commands that are specified in
2131 the TCL list @var{post_init_commands}. The commands are executed in the
2132 same order they occupy in the list. If one of the commands fails, then
2133 the error is propagated and OpenOCD fails too.
2134 @example
2135 lappend post_init_commands @{echo "OpenOCD successfully initialized."@}
2136 lappend post_init_commands @{echo "Have fun with OpenOCD !"@}
2137 @end example
2138 @end deffn
2139
2140 @deffn {Config Command} {noinit}
2141 Prevent OpenOCD from implicit @command{init} call at the end of startup.
2142 Allows issuing configuration commands over telnet or Tcl connection.
2143 When you are done with configuration use @command{init} to enter
2144 the run stage.
2145 @end deffn
2146
2147 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {jtag_init}
2148 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2149 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2150
2151 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2152 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2153 scan chain.
2154 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2155 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2156
2157 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2158 they return.
2159 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2160 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2161 @end deffn
2162
2163 @anchor{tcpipports}
2164 @section TCP/IP Ports
2165 @cindex TCP port
2166 @cindex server
2167 @cindex port
2168 @cindex security
2169 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2170 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2171 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2172
2173 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2174 access using one or more of these ports.
2175 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2176 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2177 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2178
2179 @anchor{gdb_port}
2180 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_port} [number]
2181 @cindex GDB server
2182 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2183 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2184 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2185 the normal use cases.
2186
2187 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2188 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2189 disables the gdb server.
2190
2191 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2192 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2193
2194 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2195 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2196 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2197
2198 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2199 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2200 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2201 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2202 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2203 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2204 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2205 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2206 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2207
2208 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2209 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2210 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2211 @end deffn
2212
2213 @deffn {Config Command} {tcl_port} [number]
2214 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2215 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2216 output from the Tcl engine.
2217 Intended as a machine interface.
2218 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2219 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2220 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2221 @end deffn
2222
2223 @deffn {Config Command} {telnet_port} [number]
2224 Specify or query the
2225 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2226 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2227 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2228 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2229 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2230 @end deffn
2231
2232 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2233 @section GDB Configuration
2234 @cindex GDB
2235 @cindex GDB configuration
2236 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2237 The ones listed here are static and global.
2238 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2239 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2240
2241 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2242 @deffn {Command} {gdb_breakpoint_override} [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2243 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2244 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2245 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2246 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2247 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2248 @end deffn
2249
2250 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2251 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_flash_program} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2252 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2253 vFlash packet is received.
2254 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2255 @end deffn
2256
2257 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_memory_map} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2258 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2259 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2260 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2261 for flash programming to work.
2262 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2263 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2264 @end deffn
2265
2266 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_data_abort} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2267 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2268 by GDB memory read packets.
2269 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2270 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2271 @end deffn
2272
2273 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_register_access_error} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2274 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2275 packets report errors or not.
2276 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2277 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2278 @end deffn
2279
2280 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_target_description} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2281 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2282 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2283 @end deffn
2284
2285 @deffn {Command} {gdb_save_tdesc}
2286 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2287
2288 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2289 @end deffn
2290
2291 @anchor{eventpolling}
2292 @section Event Polling
2293
2294 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2295 where significant events can happen at any time.
2296 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2297 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2298 or to GDB.
2299
2300 Examples of such events include:
2301
2302 @itemize
2303 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2304 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2305 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2306 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2307 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2308 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2309 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2310 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2311 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2312 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2313 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2314 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2315 @end itemize
2316
2317 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2318 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2319 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2320 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2321 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2322
2323 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2324 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2325 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2326 to the various active targets.
2327 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2328 which is normally done in the background.
2329
2330 @deffn {Command} {poll} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2331 Poll the current target for its current state.
2332 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2333 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2334 specific information about the current state is printed.
2335 An optional parameter
2336 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2337
2338 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2339 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2340 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2341 @example
2342 > poll
2343 background polling: on
2344 target state: halted
2345 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2346 current mode: Supervisor
2347 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2348 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2349 >
2350 @end example
2351 @end deffn
2352
2353 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2354 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2355 @cindex config file, interface
2356 @cindex interface config file
2357
2358 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2359 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2360 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2361
2362 @quotation Note
2363 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2364 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2365 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2366 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2367 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2368 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2369 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2370 @end quotation
2371
2372 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2373 through commands in an interface configuration
2374 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2375 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2376
2377 @example
2378 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2379 @end example
2380
2381 These commands tell
2382 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2383 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2384
2385 @example
2386 # jlink interface
2387 adapter driver jlink
2388 @end example
2389
2390 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2391
2392
2393 @section Adapter Configuration
2394
2395 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2396 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2397 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2398
2399 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2400 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2401 target.
2402 @end deffn
2403
2404 @deffn {Command} {adapter list}
2405 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2406 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2407 @end deffn
2408 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter transports} transport_name+
2409 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2410 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2411 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2412 the hardware can support.
2413 @end deffn
2414
2415 @anchor{adapter gpio}
2416 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter gpio [ @
2417 @option{tdo} | @option{tdi} | @option{tms} | @option{tck} | @option{trst} | @
2418 @option{swdio} | @option{swdio_dir} | @option{swclk} | @option{srst} | @
2419 @option{led} @
2420 [ @
2421 gpio_number | @option{-chip} chip_number | @
2422 @option{-active-high} | @option{-active-low} | @
2423 @option{-push-pull} | @option{-open-drain} | @option{-open-source} | @
2424 @option{-pull-none} | @option{-pull-up} | @option{-pull-down} | @
2425 @option{-init-inactive} | @option{-init-active} | @option{-init-input} @
2426 ] ]}
2427
2428 Define the GPIO mapping that the adapter will use. The following signals can be
2429 defined:
2430
2431 @itemize @minus
2432 @item @option{tdo}, @option{tdi}, @option{tms}, @option{tck}, @option{trst}:
2433 JTAG transport signals
2434 @item @option{swdio}, @option{swclk}: SWD transport signals
2435 @item @option{swdio_dir}: optional swdio buffer control signal
2436 @item @option{srst}: system reset signal
2437 @item @option{led}: optional activity led
2438
2439 @end itemize
2440
2441 Some adapters require that the GPIO chip number is set in addition to the GPIO
2442 number. The configuration options enable signals to be defined as active-high or
2443 active-low. The output drive mode can be set to push-pull, open-drain or
2444 open-source. Most adapters will have to emulate open-drain or open-source drive
2445 modes by switching between an input and output. Input and output signals can be
2446 instructed to use a pull-up or pull-down resistor, assuming it is supported by
2447 the adaptor driver and hardware. The initial state of outputs may also be set,
2448 "active" state means 1 for active-high outputs and 0 for active-low outputs.
2449 Bidirectional signals may also be initialized as an input. If the swdio signal
2450 is buffered the buffer direction can be controlled with the swdio_dir signal;
2451 the active state means that the buffer should be set as an output with respect
2452 to the adapter. The command options are cumulative with later commands able to
2453 override settings defined by earlier ones. The two commands @command{gpio led 7
2454 -active-high} and @command{gpio led -chip 1 -active-low} sent sequentially are
2455 equivalent to issuing the single command @command{gpio led 7 -chip 1
2456 -active-low}. It is not permissible to set the drive mode or initial state for
2457 signals which are inputs. The drive mode for the srst and trst signals must be
2458 set with the @command{adapter reset_config} command. It is not permissible to
2459 set the initial state of swdio_dir as it is derived from the initial state of
2460 swdio. The command @command{adapter gpio} prints the current configuration for
2461 all GPIOs while the command @command{adapter gpio gpio_name} prints the current
2462 configuration for gpio_name. Not all adapters support this generic GPIO mapping,
2463 some require their own commands to define the GPIOs used. Adapters that support
2464 the generic mapping may not support all of the listed options.
2465 @end deffn
2466
2467 @deffn {Command} {adapter name}
2468 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2469 @end deffn
2470
2471 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2472 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2473 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2474 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2475 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2476 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2477 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2478
2479 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2480 @end deffn
2481
2482 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter serial} serial_string
2483 Specifies the @var{serial_string} of the adapter to use.
2484 If this command is not specified, serial strings are not checked.
2485 Only the following adapter drivers use the serial string from this command:
2486 aice (aice_usb), arm-jtag-ew, cmsis_dap, ft232r, ftdi, hla (stlink, ti-icdi), jlink, kitprog, opendus,
2487 openjtag, osbdm, presto, rlink, st-link, usb_blaster (ublast2), usbprog, vsllink, xds110.
2488 @end deffn
2489
2490 @section Interface Drivers
2491
2492 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2493 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2494 available at run time.
2495
2496 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2497 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2498 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2499 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2500
2501 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} number
2502 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2503 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2504 @end deffn
2505
2506 @deffn {Config Command} {rtck} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2507 Displays status of RTCK option.
2508 Optionally sets that option first.
2509 @end deffn
2510 @end deffn
2511
2512 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2513 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2514 This has one driver-specific command:
2515
2516 @deffn {Command} {armjtagew_info}
2517 Logs some status
2518 @end deffn
2519 @end deffn
2520
2521 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2522 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2523 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2524 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2525 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2526 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2527 @end deffn
2528
2529 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2530 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter v1 (USB HID based)
2531 or v2 (USB bulk).
2532
2533 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2534 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2535 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2536 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2537 @example
2538 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2539 @end example
2540 @end deffn
2541
2542 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_backend} [@option{auto}|@option{usb_bulk}|@option{hid}]
2543 Specifies how to communicate with the adapter:
2544
2545 @itemize @minus
2546 @item @option{hid} Use HID generic reports - CMSIS-DAP v1
2547 @item @option{usb_bulk} Use USB bulk - CMSIS-DAP v2
2548 @item @option{auto} First try USB bulk CMSIS-DAP v2, if not found try HID CMSIS-DAP v1.
2549 This is the default if @command{cmsis_dap_backend} is not specified.
2550 @end itemize
2551 @end deffn
2552
2553 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_usb interface} [number]
2554 Specifies the @var{number} of the USB interface to use in v2 mode (USB bulk).
2555 In most cases need not to be specified and interfaces are searched by
2556 interface string or for user class interface.
2557 @end deffn
2558
2559 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2560 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2561 @end deffn
2562
2563 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap cmd} number number ...
2564 Execute an arbitrary CMSIS-DAP command. Use for adapter testing or for handling
2565 of an adapter vendor specific command from a Tcl script.
2566
2567 Take given numbers as bytes, assemble a CMSIS-DAP protocol command packet
2568 from them and send it to the adapter. The first 4 bytes of the adapter response
2569 are logged.
2570 See @url{https://arm-software.github.io/CMSIS_5/DAP/html/group__DAP__Commands__gr.html}
2571 @end deffn
2572 @end deffn
2573
2574 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2575 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2576 @end deffn
2577
2578 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2579 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2580 @end deffn
2581
2582 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2583 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2584 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2585
2586 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2587 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi.
2588
2589 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2590 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2591
2592 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2593 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2594 controlled using the @command{ftdi set_signal} command. Special signal names
2595 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2596 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2597 @command{ftdi get_signal} command.
2598
2599 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2600 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2601 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2602 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2603 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2604
2605 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2606 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2607 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2608 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2609
2610 @itemize @minus
2611 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2612 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2613 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2614 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2615 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2616 switching data and direction as necessary
2617 @end itemize
2618
2619 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2620 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2621
2622 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2623 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2624 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2625 @example
2626 ftdi vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2627 @end example
2628 @end deffn
2629
2630 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi device_desc} description
2631 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2632 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2633 during device selection.
2634 @end deffn
2635
2636 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi channel} channel
2637 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2638 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2639 @end deffn
2640
2641 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi layout_init} data direction
2642 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2643 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2644 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2645 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2646 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2647 and initially asserted reset signals.
2648 @end deffn
2649
2650 @deffn {Command} {ftdi layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2651 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2652 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2653 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2654 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2655 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2656 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2657 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2658 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2659 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2660 with the method @command{ftdi get_signal}.
2661
2662 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2663 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2664 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2665 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2666 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2667 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2668
2669 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2670 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2671 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2672 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2673 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2674 are always driven by the FTDI.
2675
2676 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2677 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2678 @var{name}.
2679 @end deffn
2680
2681 @deffn {Command} {ftdi set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2682 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2683 @itemize @minus
2684 @item @option{0}, drive low
2685 @item @option{1}, drive high
2686 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2687 @end itemize
2688 @end deffn
2689
2690 @deffn {Command} {ftdi get_signal} name
2691 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2692 @end deffn
2693
2694 @deffn {Command} {ftdi tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2695 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2696
2697 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2698 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2699 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2700 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2701 @itemize @minus
2702 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2703 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2704 @end itemize
2705 @end deffn
2706
2707 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2708 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2709
2710 @end deffn
2711
2712 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2713 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2714 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2715 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2716
2717 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2718 @itemize @minus
2719 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2720 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2721 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2722 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2723 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2724 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2725 @end itemize
2726
2727 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2728 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2729 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2730 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2731 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2732 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2733 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2734 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2735
2736 FT232R
2737 @itemize @minus
2738 @item bit 7 - RI
2739 @item bit 6 - DCD
2740 @item bit 5 - DSR
2741 @item bit 4 - DTR
2742 @item bit 3 - CTS
2743 @item bit 2 - RTS
2744 @item bit 1 - RXD
2745 @item bit 0 - TXD
2746 @end itemize
2747
2748 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2749 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2750
2751 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2752 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2753 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2754 @end deffn
2755
2756 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2757 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2758 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2759 @end deffn
2760
2761 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tck_num} @var{tck}
2762 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2763 @end deffn
2764
2765 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tms_num} @var{tms}
2766 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2767 @end deffn
2768
2769 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2770 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2771 @end deffn
2772
2773 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2774 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2775 @end deffn
2776
2777 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r trst_num} @var{trst}
2778 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2779 @end deffn
2780
2781 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r srst_num} @var{srst}
2782 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2783 @end deffn
2784
2785 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r restore_serial} @var{word}
2786 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2787 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2788 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2789 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2790 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2791 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2792 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2793 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2794 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2795 @end deffn
2796
2797 @end deffn
2798
2799 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2800 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2801 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2802 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2803
2804 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2805 processors which are being simulated.
2806
2807 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang port} number
2808 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2809 sockets instead of TCP.
2810 @end deffn
2811
2812 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang host} hostname
2813 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2814 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang port is 0.
2815 @end deffn
2816
2817 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2818 something like:
2819
2820 @example
2821 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2822 remote_bitbang port 3335
2823 remote_bitbang host foobar
2824 @end example
2825
2826 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2827 named mysocket:
2828
2829 @example
2830 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2831 remote_bitbang port 0
2832 remote_bitbang host mysocket
2833 @end example
2834 @end deffn
2835
2836 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2837 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2838 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2839 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2840
2841 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster vid_pid} vid pid
2842 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2843 default values are used.
2844 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2845 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2846 @example
2847 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2848 @end example
2849 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2850 @example
2851 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2852 @end example
2853 @end deffn
2854
2855 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2856 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2857 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2858 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2859 target board.
2860
2861 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2862 @example
2863 usb_blaster pin pin6 s
2864 reset_config srst_only
2865 @end example
2866 @end deffn
2867
2868 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2869 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2870 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2871 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2872 @end deffn
2873
2874 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster firmware} @var{path}
2875 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2876 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2877 @end deffn
2878
2879 @end deffn
2880
2881 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2882 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2883 This has one driver-specific command:
2884
2885 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2886 Display either the address of the I/O port
2887 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2888 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2889 This is a write-once setting.
2890 @end deffn
2891 @end deffn
2892
2893 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2894 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2895 transports.
2896
2897 @quotation Compatibility Note
2898 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2899 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2900 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2901 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2902 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2903 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2904 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2905 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2906 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2907 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2908 @end quotation
2909
2910 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2911 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2912 states.
2913 @end deffn
2914 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2915 Display free device internal memory.
2916 @end deffn
2917 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2918 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2919 command version.
2920 @end deffn
2921 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2922 Display the device configuration.
2923 @end deffn
2924 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2925 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2926 power state.
2927 @end deffn
2928 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2929 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2930 @end deffn
2931 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2932 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2933 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2934 IP configuration.
2935 @end deffn
2936 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2937 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2938 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2939 @end deffn
2940 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2941 Reset the current configuration.
2942 @end deffn
2943 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2944 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2945 @end deffn
2946 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write} <channel> <data>
2947 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2948 pairs.
2949
2950 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2951 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2952 @example
2953 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2954 @end example
2955 @end deffn
2956 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read} <channel> <length>
2957 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2958 pairs.
2959
2960 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2961 @example
2962 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2963 77a90000
2964 @end example
2965 @end deffn
2966 @deffn {Config Command} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2967 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2968 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2969 selection via USB address is not always unambiguous. It is recommended to use
2970 the serial number instead, if possible.
2971
2972 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2973 @end deffn
2974 @end deffn
2975
2976 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2977 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2978 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2979 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2980 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2981 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2982 configuration script.
2983
2984 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2985 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2986 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2987 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2988 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2989
2990 Known limitations:
2991 @itemize @bullet
2992 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2993 and 2.7 MHz.
2994 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2995 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2996 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2997 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2998 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2999 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
3000 communications with the target.
3001 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
3002 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
3003 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
3004 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
3005 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
3006 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
3007 @end itemize
3008
3009 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
3010 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
3011 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
3012 @end deffn
3013
3014 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
3015 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
3016 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
3017 target as a side-effect.
3018 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
3019 @end deffn
3020
3021 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
3022 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
3023 version, and target voltage.
3024 @end deffn
3025 @end deffn
3026
3027 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
3028 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
3029 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
3030 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
3031 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
3032
3033 @deffn {Config Command} {parport cable} name
3034 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
3035 This is a write-once setting.
3036 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
3037
3038 @itemize @minus
3039 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
3040 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
3041 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
3042 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
3043 in configuration mode. This is only used to
3044 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
3045 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
3046 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
3047 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
3048 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
3049 some versions of
3050 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
3051 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
3052 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
3053 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
3054 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
3055 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
3056 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
3057 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
3058 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
3059 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
3060 @end itemize
3061 @end deffn
3062
3063 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
3064 Display either the address of the I/O port
3065 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
3066 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
3067 This is a write-once setting.
3068
3069 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
3070 @option{parport port 0} (the default). If @option{parport port 0x378} is specified
3071 you may encounter a problem.
3072 @end deffn
3073
3074 @deffn {Config Command} {parport toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
3075 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
3076 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
3077 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
3078 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
3079 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
3080
3081 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
3082 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
3083 @quotation Tip
3084 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
3085 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
3086 @example
3087 > parport toggling_time 1000
3088 > adapter speed 500
3089 @end example
3090 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
3091 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
3092 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
3093 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3094 large set of samples.
3095 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3096 @example
3097 > parport toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3098 @end example
3099 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
3100 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3101
3102 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3103 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3104 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3105 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3106 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
3107 be conservative.
3108 @end quotation
3109 @end deffn
3110
3111 @deffn {Config Command} {parport write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3112 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3113 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3114 @end deffn
3115
3116 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3117 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3118
3119 @example
3120 adapter driver parport
3121 parport port 0x278
3122 parport cable wiggler
3123 @end example
3124 @end deffn
3125
3126 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3127 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3128 @end deffn
3129
3130 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3131 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3132 @end deffn
3133
3134 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3135 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3136 @end deffn
3137
3138 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3139 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3140
3141 @quotation Note
3142 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3143 which are not currently documented here.
3144 @end quotation
3145 @end deffn
3146
3147 @anchor{hla_interface}
3148 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3149 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3150 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3151 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3152
3153 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
3154 and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
3155 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3156 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3157 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3158 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3159
3160 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3161 Currently Not Supported.
3162 @end deffn
3163
3164 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
3165 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3166 @end deffn
3167
3168 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3169 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3170 @end deffn
3171
3172 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_stlink_backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3173 @emph{ST-Link only:} Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3174 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3175
3176 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3177 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3178 ST-LINK server software module}.
3179 @end deffn
3180
3181 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3182 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3183 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3184 @end deffn
3185 @end deffn
3186
3187 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3188 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3189 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3190 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3191 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3192
3193 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3194 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3195 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3196 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3197
3198 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3199 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3200
3201 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3202 Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3203 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3204
3205 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3206 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3207 ST-LINK server software module}.
3208
3209 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server does not support the SWIM transport.
3210 @end deffn
3211
3212 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3213 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3214 @end deffn
3215
3216 @deffn {Command} {st-link cmd} rx_n (tx_byte)+
3217 Sends an arbitrary command composed by the sequence of bytes @var{tx_byte}
3218 and receives @var{rx_n} bytes.
3219
3220 For example, the command to read the target's supply voltage is one byte 0xf7 followed
3221 by 15 bytes zero. It returns 8 bytes, where the first 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling
3222 of the reference voltage 1.2V and the last 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling of half
3223 the target's supply voltage.
3224 @example
3225 > st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
3226 0xf1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x0b 0x08 0x00 0x00
3227 @end example
3228 The result can be converted to Volts (ignoring the most significant bytes, always zero)
3229 @example
3230 > set a [st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0]
3231 > set n [expr @{[lindex $a 4] + 256 * [lindex $a 5]@}]
3232 > set d [expr @{[lindex $a 0] + 256 * [lindex $a 1]@}]
3233 > echo [expr @{2 * 1.2 * $n / $d@}]
3234 3.24891518738
3235 @end example
3236 @end deffn
3237 @end deffn
3238
3239 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3240 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3241 @end deffn
3242
3243 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3244 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3245 @end deffn
3246
3247 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3248 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3249 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3250 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3251 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3252
3253 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3254 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3255 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3256 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3257 @end deffn
3258
3259 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3260 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3261 version).
3262 @end deffn
3263 @end deffn
3264
3265 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3266 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3267 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3268 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3269 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3270
3271 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3272
3273 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc config} device
3274 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3275
3276 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3277 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3278
3279 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3280
3281 @end deffn
3282 @end deffn
3283
3284 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3285 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3286 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3287
3288 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3289 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3290 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3291 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3292 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3293 configuration on exit.
3294
3295 GPIO numbers >= 32 can't be used for performance reasons.
3296
3297 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3298 pinout.
3299
3300 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
3301 Set JTAG transport GPIO numbers for TCK, TMS, TDI, and TDO (in that order).
3302 Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. These pins can also be specified
3303 individually.
3304 @end deffn
3305
3306 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tck_num} @var{tck}
3307 Set TCK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3308 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3309 @end deffn
3310
3311 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tms_num} @var{tms}
3312 Set TMS GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3313 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3314 @end deffn
3315
3316 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdo_num} @var{tdo}
3317 Set TDO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3318 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3319 @end deffn
3320
3321 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdi_num} @var{tdi}
3322 Set TDI GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3323 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3324 @end deffn
3325
3326 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swd_nums} @var{swclk} @var{swdio}
3327 Set SWD transport GPIO numbers for SWCLK and SWDIO (in that order). Must be
3328 specified to enable SWD transport. These pins can also be specified individually.
3329 @end deffn
3330
3331 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swclk_num} @var{swclk}
3332 Set SWCLK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3333 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
3334 @end deffn
3335
3336 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_num} @var{swdio}
3337 Set SWDIO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3338 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
3339 @end deffn
3340
3341 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_dir_num} @var{swdio} @var{dir}
3342 Set SWDIO direction control pin GPIO number. If specified, this pin can be used
3343 to control the direction of an external buffer on the SWDIO pin (set=output
3344 mode, clear=input mode). If not specified, this feature is disabled.
3345 @end deffn
3346
3347 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio srst_num} @var{srst}
3348 Set SRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SRST.
3349 @end deffn
3350
3351 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio trst_num} @var{trst}
3352 Set TRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable TRST.
3353 @end deffn
3354
3355 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio speed_coeffs} @var{speed_coeff} @var{speed_offset}
3356 Set SPEED_COEFF and SPEED_OFFSET for delay calculations. If unspecified,
3357 speed_coeff defaults to 113714, and speed_offset defaults to 28.
3358 @end deffn
3359
3360 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio peripheral_base} @var{base}
3361 Set the peripheral base register address to access GPIOs. For the RPi1, use
3362 0x20000000. For RPi2 and RPi3, use 0x3F000000. For RPi4, use 0xFE000000. A full
3363 list can be found in the
3364 @uref{https://www.raspberrypi.org/documentation/hardware/raspberrypi/peripheral_addresses.md, official guide}.
3365 @end deffn
3366
3367 @end deffn
3368
3369 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3370 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3371 of the one which is most popular.
3372
3373 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3374
3375 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3376 pinout.
3377
3378 @end deffn
3379
3380
3381 @deffn {Interface Driver} {am335xgpio} The AM335x SoC is present in BeagleBone
3382 Black and BeagleBone Green single-board computers which expose some of the GPIOs
3383 on the two expansion headers.
3384
3385 For maximum performance the driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral
3386 registers directly. The memory mapping requires read and write permission to
3387 kernel memory; if /dev/gpiomem exists it will be used, otherwise /dev/mem will
3388 be used. The driver restores the GPIO state on exit.
3389
3390 All four GPIO ports are available. GPIO configuration is handled by the generic
3391 command @ref{adapter gpio, @command{adapter gpio}}.
3392
3393 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio speed_coeffs} @var{speed_coeff} @var{speed_offset}
3394 Set SPEED_COEFF and SPEED_OFFSET for delay calculations. If unspecified
3395 speed_coeff defaults to 600000 and speed_offset defaults to 575.
3396 @end deffn
3397
3398 See @file{interface/beaglebone-swd-native.cfg} for a sample configuration file.
3399
3400 @end deffn
3401
3402
3403 @deffn {Interface Driver} {linuxgpiod}
3404 Linux provides userspace access to GPIO through libgpiod since Linux kernel
3405 version v4.6. The driver emulates either JTAG or SWD transport through
3406 bitbanging. There are no driver-specific commands, all GPIO configuration is
3407 handled by the generic command @ref{adapter gpio, @command{adapter gpio}}. This
3408 driver supports the resistor pull options provided by the @command{adapter gpio}
3409 command but the underlying hardware may not be able to support them.
3410
3411 See @file{interface/dln-2-gpiod.cfg} for a sample configuration file.
3412 @end deffn
3413
3414
3415 @deffn {Interface Driver} {sysfsgpio}
3416 Linux legacy userspace access to GPIO through sysfs is deprecated from Linux kernel version v5.3.
3417 Prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}, instead.
3418
3419 See @file{interface/sysfsgpio-raspberrypi.cfg} for a sample config.
3420 @end deffn
3421
3422
3423 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3424 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3425 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3426
3427 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag variant} variant
3428 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3429 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3430
3431 @itemize @minus
3432 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3433 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3434 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3435 @end itemize
3436 @end deffn
3437
3438 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag device_desc} string
3439 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3440 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3441 @end deffn
3442 @end deffn
3443
3444
3445 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vdebug}
3446 Cadence Virtual Debug Interface driver.
3447
3448 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug server} host:port
3449 Specifies the host and TCP port number where the vdebug server runs.
3450 @end deffn
3451
3452 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug batching} value
3453 Specifies the batching method for the vdebug request. Possible values are
3454 0 for no batching
3455 1 or wr to batch write transactions together (default)
3456 2 or rw to batch both read and write transactions
3457 @end deffn
3458
3459 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug polling} min max
3460 Takes two values, representing the polling interval in ms. Lower values mean faster
3461 debugger responsiveness, but lower emulation performance. The minimum should be
3462 around 10, maximum should not exceed 1000, which is the default gdb and keepalive
3463 timeout value.
3464 @end deffn
3465
3466 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug bfm_path} path clk_period
3467 Specifies the hierarchical path and input clk period of the vdebug BFM in the design.
3468 The hierarchical path uses Verilog notation top.inst.inst
3469 The clock period must include the unit, for instance 40ns.
3470 @end deffn
3471
3472 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug mem_path} path base size
3473 Specifies the hierarchical path to the design memory instance for backdoor access.
3474 Up to 4 memories can be specified. The hierarchical path uses Verilog notation.
3475 The base specifies start address in the design address space, size its size in bytes.
3476 Both values can use hexadecimal notation with prefix 0x.
3477 @end deffn
3478 @end deffn
3479
3480 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
3481 SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
3482 JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
3483 DPI server interface.
3484
3485 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_port} port
3486 Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3487 @end deffn
3488
3489 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_address} address
3490 Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3491 @end deffn
3492 @end deffn
3493
3494
3495 @deffn {Interface Driver} {buspirate}
3496
3497 This driver is for the Bus Pirate (see @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/docs/Bus_Pirate}) and compatible devices.
3498 It uses a simple data protocol over a serial port connection.
3499
3500 Most hardware development boards have a UART, a real serial port, or a virtual USB serial device, so this driver
3501 allows you to start building your own JTAG adapter without the complexity of a custom USB connection.
3502
3503 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate port} serial_port
3504 Specify the serial port's filename. For example:
3505 @example
3506 buspirate port /dev/ttyUSB0
3507 @end example
3508 @end deffn
3509
3510 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate speed} (normal|fast)
3511 Set the communication speed to 115k (normal) or 1M (fast). For example:
3512 @example
3513 buspirate speed normal
3514 @end example
3515 @end deffn
3516
3517 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate mode} (normal|open-drain)
3518 Set the Bus Pirate output mode.
3519 @itemize @minus
3520 @item In normal mode (push/pull), do not enable the pull-ups, and do not connect I/O header pin VPU to JTAG VREF.
3521 @item In open drain mode, you will then need to enable the pull-ups.
3522 @end itemize
3523 For example:
3524 @example
3525 buspirate mode normal
3526 @end example
3527 @end deffn
3528
3529 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate pullup} (0|1)
3530 Whether to connect (1) or not (0) the I/O header pin VPU (JTAG VREF)
3531 to the pull-up/pull-down resistors on MOSI (JTAG TDI), CLK (JTAG TCK), MISO (JTAG TDO) and CS (JTAG TMS).
3532 For example:
3533 @example
3534 buspirate pullup 0
3535 @end example
3536 @end deffn
3537
3538 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate vreg} (0|1)
3539 Whether to enable (1) or disable (0) the built-in voltage regulator,
3540 which can be used to supply power to a test circuit through
3541 I/O header pins +3V3 and +5V. For example:
3542 @example
3543 buspirate vreg 0
3544 @end example
3545 @end deffn
3546
3547 @deffn {Command} {buspirate led} (0|1)
3548 Turns the Bus Pirate's LED on (1) or off (0). For example:
3549 @end deffn
3550 @example
3551 buspirate led 1
3552 @end example
3553
3554 @end deffn
3555
3556 @deffn {Interface Driver} {esp_usb_jtag}
3557 Espressif JTAG driver to communicate with ESP32-C3, ESP32-S3 chips and ESP USB Bridge board using OpenOCD.
3558 These chips have built-in JTAG circuitry and can be debugged without any additional hardware.
3559 Only an USB cable connected to the D+/D- pins is necessary.
3560
3561 @deffn {Config Command} {espusbjtag tdo}
3562 Returns the current state of the TDO line
3563 @end deffn
3564
3565 @deffn {Config Command} {espusbjtag setio} setio
3566 Manually set the status of the output lines with the order of (tdi tms tck trst srst)
3567 @example
3568 espusbjtag setio 0 1 0 1 0
3569 @end example
3570 @end deffn
3571
3572 @deffn {Config Command} {espusbjtag vid_pid} vid_pid
3573 Set vendor ID and product ID for the ESP usb jtag driver
3574 @example
3575 espusbjtag vid_pid 0x303a 0x1001
3576 @end example
3577 @end deffn
3578
3579 @deffn {Config Command} {espusbjtag caps_descriptor} caps_descriptor
3580 Set the jtag descriptor to read capabilities of ESP usb jtag driver
3581 @example
3582 espusbjtag caps_descriptor 0x2000
3583 @end example
3584 @end deffn
3585
3586 @deffn {Config Command} {espusbjtag chip_id} chip_id
3587 Set chip id to transfer to the ESP USB bridge board
3588 @example
3589 espusbjtag chip_id 1
3590 @end example
3591 @end deffn
3592
3593 @end deffn
3594
3595 @section Transport Configuration
3596 @cindex Transport
3597 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3598 and the debug adapter you are using,
3599 several transports may be available to
3600 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3601 @deffn {Command} {transport list}
3602 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3603 version of OpenOCD.
3604 @end deffn
3605
3606 @deffn {Command} {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3607 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3608
3609 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3610 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3611 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3612 adapter's driver).
3613
3614 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3615 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3616 supported by the debug adapter.
3617
3618 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3619 transport, if any.
3620 @end deffn
3621
3622 @subsection JTAG Transport
3623 @cindex JTAG
3624 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3625 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3626 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3627 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3628 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3629 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3630
3631 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3632 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3633 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3634 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3635 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3636
3637 @subsection SWD Transport
3638 @cindex SWD
3639 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3640 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3641 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3642 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3643 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3644 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3645 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3646
3647 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3648 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3649 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3650 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3651 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3652
3653 @deffn {Config Command} {swd newdap} ...
3654 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3655 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3656 expected to change.
3657 @end deffn
3658
3659 @cindex SWD multi-drop
3660 The newer SWD devices (SW-DP v2 or SWJ-DP v2) support the multi-drop extension
3661 of SWD protocol: two or more devices can be connected to one SWD adapter.
3662 SWD transport works in multi-drop mode if @ref{dap_create,DAP} is configured
3663 with both @code{-dp-id} and @code{-instance-id} parameters regardless how many
3664 DAPs are created.
3665
3666 Not all adapters and adapter drivers support SWD multi-drop. Only the following
3667 adapter drivers are SWD multi-drop capable:
3668 cmsis_dap (use an adapter with CMSIS-DAP version 2.0), ftdi, all bitbang based.
3669
3670 @subsection SPI Transport
3671 @cindex SPI
3672 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3673 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3674 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3675 solution for flash programming.
3676
3677 @anchor{swimtransport}
3678 @subsection SWIM Transport
3679 @cindex SWIM
3680 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3681 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3682 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3683 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3684
3685 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3686
3687 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3688
3689 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3690 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3691 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3692 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3693 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3694
3695 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3696 @section JTAG Speed
3697 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3698 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3699 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3700 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3701 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3702 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3703 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3704 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3705 power management software that may be active.
3706
3707 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3708 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3709 target event handler.
3710 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3711 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3712 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3713 sets up those clocks).
3714 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3715 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3716 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3717 in the target config file.
3718 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3719 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3720 config file instead.
3721 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3722 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3723 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3724
3725 @example
3726 jtag_rclk 3000
3727 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3728 @end example
3729
3730 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3731 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3732 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3733 may not be the fastest solution.
3734
3735 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3736 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3737 which support adaptive clocking.
3738
3739 @deffn {Command} {adapter speed} max_speed_kHz
3740 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3741 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3742 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3743 than the speed specified.
3744
3745 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3746 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3747 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3748 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3749
3750 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3751 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3752 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3753 JTAG clocking after setup.
3754 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3755 If the interface device can not
3756 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3757 @end deffn
3758
3759 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3760 @cindex adaptive clocking
3761 @cindex RTCK
3762 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3763 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3764 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3765 @example
3766 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3767 jtag_rclk 3000
3768 @end example
3769 @end defun
3770
3771 @node Reset Configuration
3772 @chapter Reset Configuration
3773 @cindex Reset Configuration
3774
3775 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3776 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3777 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3778 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3779 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3780 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3781 Please see the various board files for examples.
3782
3783 @quotation Note
3784 To maintainers and integrators:
3785 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3786 Normally the board configuration file
3787 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3788 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3789
3790 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3791 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3792 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3793 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3794 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3795 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3796 @end quotation
3797
3798 @section Types of Reset
3799
3800 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3801 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3802 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3803
3804 @itemize @bullet
3805 @item
3806 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3807 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3808 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3809 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3810 @item
3811 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3812 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3813 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3814 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3815 @item
3816 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3817 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3818 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3819 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3820 @item
3821 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3822 several other types of reset.
3823 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3824 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3825 There may be individual module resets.
3826 @end itemize
3827
3828 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3829 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3830 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3831 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3832 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3833 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3834 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3835 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3836 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3837
3838 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3839 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3840
3841 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3842 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3843 common issues are:
3844
3845 @itemize @bullet
3846
3847 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3848 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3849 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3850 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3851 when either of those signals is not connected.
3852 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3853 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3854 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3855 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3856
3857 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3858 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3859 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3860 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3861
3862 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3863 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3864 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3865 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3866 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3867 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3868 hardware debouncing.
3869 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3870 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3871
3872 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3873 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3874 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3875 to use push/pull output drivers.
3876 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3877 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3878 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3879 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3880
3881 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3882 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3883 issues (not limited to errata).
3884 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3885 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3886 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3887 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3888 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3889 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3890 @end itemize
3891
3892 There can also be other issues.
3893 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3894 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3895 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3896 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3897 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3898 Agreement (NDA).
3899
3900 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3901 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3902 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3903
3904 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3905 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3906
3907 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3908
3909 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst pulse_width} milliseconds
3910 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3911 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3912 allowing it to be deasserted.
3913 @end deffn
3914
3915 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst delay} milliseconds
3916 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3917 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3918 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3919 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3920 @end deffn
3921
3922 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_assert_width} milliseconds
3923 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3924 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3925 allowing it to be deasserted.
3926 @end deffn
3927
3928 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_delay} milliseconds
3929 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3930 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3931 @end deffn
3932
3933 @anchor{reset_config}
3934 @deffn {Command} {reset_config} mode_flag ...
3935 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3936 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3937 configuration scripts.
3938
3939 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3940 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3941 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3942 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3943 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3944 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3945 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3946 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3947
3948 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3949 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3950 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3951 -- may be specified at a time.
3952 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3953 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3954 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3955 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3956 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3957
3958 @itemize
3959 @item
3960 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3961 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3962 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3963 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3964 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3965
3966 @quotation Tip
3967 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3968 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3969 @end quotation
3970
3971 @item
3972 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3973 signal implementations.
3974 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3975 indicating everything behaves normally.
3976 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3977 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3978 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3979 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3980 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3981 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3982 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3983
3984 @item
3985 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3986 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3987 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3988 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3989 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3990 while SRST is asserted.
3991 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3992 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3993
3994 @item
3995 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3996 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3997 is required to use this option.
3998 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3999 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
4000 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
4001 be asserted before any target connection.
4002 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
4003 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
4004 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
4005 @end itemize
4006
4007 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
4008 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
4009 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
4010 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
4011 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
4012
4013 @itemize
4014 @item
4015 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
4016 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
4017 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
4018 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
4019
4020 @item
4021 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
4022 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
4023 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
4024 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
4025 power-up and pressing a reset button.
4026 @end itemize
4027 @end deffn
4028
4029 @section Custom Reset Handling
4030 @cindex events
4031
4032 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
4033 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
4034 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
4035 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
4036 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
4037 at particular points in the reset sequence.
4038
4039 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
4040 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
4041 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
4042 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
4043 want to reset everything at once.
4044
4045 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
4046 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
4047 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
4048 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
4049 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
4050 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
4051 needs special attention.
4052
4053 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
4054 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
4055 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
4056 to find a sequence of operations that works.
4057 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
4058 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
4059 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
4060 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
4061 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
4062
4063 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
4064 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
4065 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
4066 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
4067 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
4068
4069 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {init_reset} mode
4070 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
4071 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
4072 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
4073 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
4074 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
4075 low level reset command (@option{halt},
4076 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
4077 or potentially some other value.
4078
4079 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
4080 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
4081 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
4082 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
4083 (or their associated targets)
4084 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
4085
4086 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
4087 they return.
4088 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
4089 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
4090 @end deffn
4091
4092 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init}
4093 This validates the scan chain using just the four
4094 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
4095 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
4096 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
4097 matches the TAPs it can observe.
4098 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
4099 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
4100 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
4101 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
4102 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
4103 @end deffn
4104
4105 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init-reset}
4106 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
4107 everything on the JTAG scan chain
4108 (and anything else connected to SRST).
4109 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
4110 @end deffn
4111
4112
4113 @node TAP Declaration
4114 @chapter TAP Declaration
4115 @cindex TAP declaration
4116 @cindex TAP configuration
4117
4118 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
4119 TAPs serve many roles, including:
4120
4121 @itemize @bullet
4122 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
4123 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
4124 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
4125 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
4126 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
4127 start running that code.
4128 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
4129 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
4130 and missing connections.
4131 @end itemize
4132
4133 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
4134 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
4135 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
4136 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
4137 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
4138
4139 @section Scan Chains
4140 @cindex scan chain
4141
4142 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
4143 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
4144 They also need to be added to
4145 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
4146 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
4147 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
4148 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
4149 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
4150 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
4151 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
4152 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
4153
4154 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
4155 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
4156 command, presented in the next chapter.
4157 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
4158 debugging targets.)
4159 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
4160
4161 @verbatim
4162 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
4163 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
4164 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
4165 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
4166 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
4167 @end verbatim
4168
4169 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
4170 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4171 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
4172 because not all devices provide good support for that.
4173 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
4174 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
4175 until they are told to do so.
4176
4177 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
4178 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
4179 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
4180 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
4181
4182 @example
4183 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
4184 @end example
4185
4186 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
4187 by a given chip.
4188 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
4189 and so forth.
4190 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
4191 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
4192 both inside a single chip and between them.
4193 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
4194
4195 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
4196 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
4197 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
4198 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
4199 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
4200 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
4201 includes commands something like this:
4202
4203 @example
4204 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
4205 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
4206 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
4207 @end example
4208
4209 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
4210 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
4211 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
4212
4213 @deffn {Command} {jtag names}
4214 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
4215 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
4216 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
4217 @example
4218 foreach t [jtag names] @{
4219 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
4220 @}
4221 @end example
4222 @end deffn
4223
4224 @deffn {Command} {scan_chain}
4225 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
4226 and their status.
4227 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
4228 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
4229 but systems with a JTAG router can
4230 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
4231 @end deffn
4232
4233 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
4234 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
4235
4236 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
4237 @c (on entry to RESET state).
4238
4239 @section TAP Names
4240 @cindex dotted name
4241
4242 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
4243 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
4244 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
4245 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
4246 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
4247 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
4248 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
4249 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
4250
4251 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
4252 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
4253 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
4254
4255 @section TAP Declaration Commands
4256
4257 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
4258 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
4259 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
4260
4261 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
4262 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
4263 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
4264 overridable.
4265
4266 @cindex TAP naming convention
4267 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
4268 and should follow this convention:
4269
4270 @itemize @bullet
4271 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
4272 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
4273 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
4274 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
4275 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
4276 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
4277 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
4278 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
4279 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
4280 with a single TAP;
4281 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
4282 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
4283 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
4284 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
4285 @end itemize
4286
4287 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
4288
4289 @itemize @bullet
4290 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
4291 @*The length in bits of the
4292 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
4293 @end itemize
4294
4295 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4296
4297 @itemize @bullet
4298 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
4299 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
4300 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
4301 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
4302 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
4303 (the TAP is linked in).
4304 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
4305 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
4306 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
4307 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
4308 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
4309 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
4310 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
4311 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
4312 values that were found but not included in the list.
4313
4314 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
4315 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
4316 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
4317 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
4318 hardware to find these values.
4319 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4320 @item @code{-ignore-version}
4321 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
4322 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
4323 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
4324 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
4325 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
4326 @item @code{-ignore-bypass}
4327 @*Specify this to ignore the 'bypass' bit of the idcode. Some vendor put
4328 an invalid idcode regarding this bit. Specify this to ignore this bit and
4329 to not consider this tap in bypass mode.
4330 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
4331 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
4332 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
4333 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
4334 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
4335 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
4336 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
4337 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
4338 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
4339 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
4340 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
4341 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
4342 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
4343 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4344 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4345 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4346 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4347 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4348 @end itemize
4349 @end deffn
4350
4351 @section Other TAP commands
4352
4353 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
4354 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
4355 @end deffn
4356
4357 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
4358 @deffnx {Command} {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
4359 At this writing this TAP attribute
4360 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
4361 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
4362 mechanism for debugger targets.)
4363 See the next section for information about the available events.
4364
4365 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
4366 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
4367 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
4368 @end deffn
4369
4370 @section TAP Events
4371 @cindex events
4372 @cindex TAP events
4373
4374 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4375 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4376 The other applies to debugger targets,
4377 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4378
4379 The TAP events currently defined are:
4380
4381 @itemize @bullet
4382 @item @b{post-reset}
4383 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4384 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4385 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4386 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4387 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4388
4389 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4390 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4391 of any particular target.
4392 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4393 @item @b{setup}
4394 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4395 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4396 @item @b{tap-disable}
4397 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4398 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4399 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4400 @item @b{tap-enable}
4401 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4402 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4403 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4404 @end itemize
4405
4406 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4407 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4408 contents to be accurate), you might:
4409
4410 @example
4411 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4412 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4413 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4414 @}
4415 @end example
4416
4417
4418 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4419 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4420 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4421 @cindex jrc
4422
4423 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4424 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4425 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4426 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4427 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4428
4429 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4430 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4431 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4432 be visible.
4433 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4434 ignores, such as:
4435
4436 @itemize
4437 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4438 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4439 TAPs receive new instructions.
4440 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4441 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4442 @end itemize
4443
4444 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4445 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4446 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4447 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4448
4449 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4450 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4451
4452 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4453 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4454 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4455 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4456 should define TAP event handlers using
4457 code that looks something like this:
4458
4459 @example
4460 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4461 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4462 @}
4463 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4464 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4465 @}
4466 @end example
4467
4468 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4469
4470 @example
4471 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4472 @end example
4473
4474 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4475 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4476 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4477 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4478
4479 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4480 If necessary, disables the tap
4481 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4482 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4483 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4484 and "0" if it is disabled.
4485 @end deffn
4486
4487 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4488 If necessary, enables the tap
4489 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4490 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4491 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4492 and "0" if it is disabled.
4493 @end deffn
4494
4495 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4496 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4497 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4498 and "0" if it is disabled.
4499
4500 @quotation Note
4501 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4502 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4503 @end quotation
4504 @end deffn
4505
4506 @anchor{autoprobing}
4507 @section Autoprobing
4508 @cindex autoprobe
4509 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4510
4511 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4512 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4513 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4514 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4515
4516 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4517 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4518 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4519 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4520 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4521 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4522 right when they come out of reset).
4523
4524 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4525
4526 @example
4527 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4528 reset_config trst_and_srst
4529 jtag_rclk 8
4530 @end example
4531
4532 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4533 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4534
4535 @enumerate
4536 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4537 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4538 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4539 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4540 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4541 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4542 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4543 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4544 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4545 that is discovered.
4546 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4547 register, it will report it.
4548 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4549 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4550 @end enumerate
4551
4552 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4553 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4554 that's a bit more complex:
4555
4556 @example
4557 clock speed 8 kHz
4558 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4559 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4560 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4561 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4562 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4563 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4564 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4565 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4566 @end example
4567
4568 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4569 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4570 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4571 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4572 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4573 and so forth.
4574
4575 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4576 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4577 @cindex DAP declaration
4578
4579 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4580 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4581 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4582 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4583 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4584
4585 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4586
4587 @anchor{dap_create}
4588 @deffn {Command} {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4589 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4590 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4591 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4592 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4593
4594 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4595
4596 @itemize @bullet
4597 @item @code{-adiv5}
4598 Specify that it's an ADIv5 DAP. This is the default if not specified.
4599 @item @code{-adiv6}
4600 Specify that it's an ADIv6 DAP.
4601 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4602 Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4603 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4604 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4605 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4606
4607 @item @code{-dp-id} @var{number}
4608 @*Debug port identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4609 The @var{number} is written to bits 0..27 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4610 To find the id number of a single connected device read DP TARGETID:
4611 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x24}
4612 Use bits 0..27 of TARGETID.
4613
4614 @item @code{-instance-id} @var{number}
4615 @*Instance identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4616 The @var{number} is written to bits 28..31 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4617 To find the instance number of a single connected device read DP DLPIDR:
4618 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x34}
4619 The instance number is in bits 28..31 of DLPIDR value.
4620 @end itemize
4621 @end deffn
4622
4623 @deffn {Command} {dap names}
4624 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4625 for TCL scripting.
4626 @end deffn
4627
4628 @deffn {Command} {dap info} [@var{num}|@option{root}]
4629 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4630 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4631 On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4632 On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
4633 With ADIv6 only, @option{root} specifies the root ROM table.
4634 @end deffn
4635
4636 @deffn {Command} {dap init}
4637 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4638 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4639 initialization, too.
4640 @end deffn
4641
4642 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4643
4644 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name info} [@var{num}|@option{root}]
4645 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4646 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4647 On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4648 On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
4649 With ADIv6 only, @option{root} specifies the root ROM table.
4650 @end deffn
4651
4652 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apid} [num]
4653 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4654 On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4655 On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
4656 @end deffn
4657
4658 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4659 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4660 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4661 or set a new value @var{value}.
4662 On ADIv5 DAP @var{ap_num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4663 On ADIv6 DAP @var{ap_num} is the base address of the AP.
4664 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4665 @end deffn
4666
4667 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4668 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4669 On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4670 On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
4671 @end deffn
4672
4673 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4674 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4675 value @var{value}.
4676
4677 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4678 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4679 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4680
4681 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4682 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4683 @end deffn
4684
4685 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4686 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4687 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4688 On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4689 On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
4690 @end deffn
4691
4692 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4693 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4694 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4695 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4696 @end deffn
4697
4698 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4699 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4700
4701 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4702 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4703 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4704 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4705 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4706 for details.
4707
4708 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4709 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4710 the pattern:
4711 @example
4712 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4713 @end example
4714
4715 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4716 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4717 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4718 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4719 @example
4720 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr @{1 << 27@}]
4721 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4722 @end example
4723
4724 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4725 @example
4726 set CSW_SPROT [expr @{1 << 30@}]
4727 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4728 @end example
4729
4730 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4731 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4732
4733 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4734 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4735 example with a proper dap name:
4736 @example
4737 xxx.dap apcsw default
4738 @end example
4739 @end deffn
4740
4741 @deffn {Config Command} {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4742 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4743 Disabled by default
4744 @end deffn
4745
4746 @deffn {Config Command} {$dap_name nu_npcx_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4747 Set/get quirks mode for Nuvoton NPCX/NPCD MCU families
4748 Disabled by default
4749 @end deffn
4750
4751 @node CPU Configuration
4752 @chapter CPU Configuration
4753 @cindex GDB target
4754
4755 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4756 You can also access these targets without GDB
4757 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4758 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4759 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4760 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4761
4762 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4763 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4764
4765 @section Target List
4766 @cindex target, current
4767 @cindex target, list
4768
4769 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4770 where each member has a name.
4771 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4772 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4773 (plural!) command.
4774 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4775 look like with more than one:
4776 @verbatim
4777 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4778 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4779 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4780 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4781 @end verbatim
4782
4783 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4784 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4785 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4786 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4787 space seen by that current target.
4788 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4789 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4790 are examples; and there are many more.
4791
4792 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4793
4794 @deffn {Command} {target current}
4795 Returns the name of the current target.
4796 @end deffn
4797
4798 @deffn {Command} {target names}
4799 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4800 @example
4801 foreach t [target names] @{
4802 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4803 @}
4804 @end example
4805 @end deffn
4806
4807 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4808 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4809
4810 @deffn {Command} {targets} [name]
4811 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4812 command names are singular.}
4813
4814 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4815 targets in a user friendly form.
4816
4817 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4818 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4819 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4820 @end deffn
4821
4822 @section Target CPU Types
4823 @cindex target type
4824 @cindex CPU type
4825
4826 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4827 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4828 when calling @command{target create}.
4829 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4830 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4831 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4832 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4833 what core-specific commands may be available
4834 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4835 and more.
4836
4837 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4838 since there's a command to list them.
4839
4840 @anchor{targettypes}
4841 @deffn {Command} {target types}
4842 Lists all supported target types.
4843 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4844
4845 @itemize @bullet
4846 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4847 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4848 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4849 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4850 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4851 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4852 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4853 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4854 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4855 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4856 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4857 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4858 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4859 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4860 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4861 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4862 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4863 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4864 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4865 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4866 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4867 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4868 @item @code{esp32} -- this is an Espressif SoC with dual Xtensa cores.
4869 @item @code{esp32s2} -- this is an Espressif SoC with single Xtensa core.
4870 @item @code{esp32s3} -- this is an Espressif SoC with dual Xtensa cores.
4871 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4872 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4873 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4874 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4875 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4876 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without
4877 a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be
4878 useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of
4879 support for new CPUs.
4880 It's possible to connect a GDB client to this target (the GDB port has to be
4881 specified, @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.), and a fake ARM core will
4882 be emulated to comply to GDB remote protocol.
4883 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4884 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4885 @item @code{nds32_v2} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v2 core (deprecated; would be removed in v0.13.0).
4886 @item @code{nds32_v3} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3 core (deprecated; would be removed in v0.13.0).
4887 @item @code{nds32_v3m} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3m core (deprecated; would be removed in v0.13.0).
4888 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4889 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4890 @itemize @minus
4891 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4892 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4893 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4894 @end itemize
4895 And two debug interfaces cores:
4896 @itemize @minus
4897 @item @code{Advanced debug interface}
4898 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4899 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface}
4900 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4901 @end itemize
4902 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4903 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4904 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4905 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4906 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4907 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4908 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4909 @end itemize
4910 @end deffn
4911
4912 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4913 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4914 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4915 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4916 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4917 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4918 reflect design generations;
4919 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4920 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4921
4922 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4923 @section Target Configuration
4924
4925 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4926 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4927 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4928 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4929 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4930
4931 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4932 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4933 optional parts.
4934 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4935 command, created as part of target creation.
4936
4937 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4938 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4939 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4940 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4941 to be much more board-specific.
4942 The key steps you use might look something like this
4943
4944 @example
4945 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4946 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4947 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4948 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4949 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4950 @end example
4951
4952 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4953 on-chip SRAM.
4954 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4955 writes to target memory;
4956 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4957 GDB memory checksumming;
4958 and more.
4959
4960 @quotation Warning
4961 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4962 inaccessible when application code
4963 (such as an operating system)
4964 enables or disables the MMU.
4965 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4966 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4967 easy access to other addresses needed.
4968 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4969 @end quotation
4970
4971 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4972 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4973 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4974 controllers.
4975 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4976 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4977 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4978
4979 @deffn {Config Command} {target create} target_name type configparams...
4980 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4981 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4982 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4983 purposes including additional configuration.
4984
4985 @itemize @bullet
4986 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4987 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4988 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4989 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4990
4991 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4992 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4993 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4994 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4995 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4996 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4997 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4998
4999 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
5000 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
5001 @end itemize
5002 @end deffn
5003
5004 @deffn {Command} {$target_name configure} configparams...
5005 The options accepted by this command may also be
5006 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
5007 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
5008 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
5009
5010 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
5011 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
5012 and changing its endianness.
5013
5014 @itemize @bullet
5015
5016 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
5017 used to access this target.
5018
5019 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
5020 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
5021 create and manage DAP instances.
5022
5023 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
5024 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
5025
5026 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
5027 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
5028 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
5029 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
5030 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
5031 same event name assigns only one handler.
5032
5033 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
5034 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
5035
5036 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
5037 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
5038 @emph{it is not backed up.}
5039 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
5040 since performing a backup slows down operations.
5041 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
5042 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
5043
5044 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
5045 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
5046 or virtual address is being used.
5047
5048 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
5049 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
5050
5051 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
5052 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
5053 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
5054 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
5055 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
5056
5057 @anchor{rtostype}
5058 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
5059 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{none}, @option{eCos},
5060 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
5061 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
5062 @option{RIOT}, @option{Zephyr}
5063 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
5064
5065 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
5066 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
5067 access the target for debugging.
5068
5069 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target.
5070 On ADIv5 DAP @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
5071 On ADIv6 DAP @var{ap_number} is the base address of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
5072 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
5073 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
5074
5075 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
5076 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
5077 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
5078 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
5079 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
5080
5081 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
5082 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
5083 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
5084 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
5085 command @command{gdb_port}.
5086 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
5087
5088 @item @code{-gdb-max-connections} @var{number} -- EXPERIMENTAL: set the maximum
5089 number of GDB connections that are allowed for the target. Default is 1.
5090 A negative value for @var{number} means unlimited connections.
5091 See @xref{gdbmeminspect,,Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}.
5092 @end itemize
5093 @end deffn
5094
5095 @section Other $target_name Commands
5096 @cindex object command
5097
5098 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
5099 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
5100
5101 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
5102 Once a button is created a button
5103 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
5104 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
5105 configure it like this:
5106
5107 @example
5108 # Create
5109 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
5110 # Modify
5111 .foobar configure -foreground blue
5112 # Query
5113 set x [.foobar cget -background]
5114 # Report
5115 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
5116 @end example
5117
5118 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
5119 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
5120
5121 @example
5122 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
5123 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
5124 @end example
5125
5126 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
5127
5128 @deffn {Command} {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
5129 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_halt}
5130 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_poll}
5131 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_reset}
5132 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_waitstate}
5133 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
5134 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
5135 They are not otherwise documented here.
5136 @end deffn
5137
5138 @deffn {Command} {$target_name set_reg} dict
5139 Set register values of the target.
5140
5141 @itemize
5142 @item @var{dict} ... Tcl dictionary with pairs of register names and values.
5143 @end itemize
5144
5145 For example, the following command sets the value 0 to the program counter (pc)
5146 register and 0x1000 to the stack pointer (sp) register:
5147
5148 @example
5149 set_reg @{pc 0 sp 0x1000@}
5150 @end example
5151 @end deffn
5152
5153 @deffn {Command} {$target_name get_reg} [-force] list
5154 Get register values from the target and return them as Tcl dictionary with pairs
5155 of register names and values.
5156 If option "-force" is set, the register values are read directly from the
5157 target, bypassing any caching.
5158
5159 @itemize
5160 @item @var{list} ... List of register names
5161 @end itemize
5162
5163 For example, the following command retrieves the values from the program
5164 counter (pc) and stack pointer (sp) register:
5165
5166 @example
5167 get_reg @{pc sp@}
5168 @end example
5169 @end deffn
5170
5171 @deffn {Command} {$target_name write_memory} address width data ['phys']
5172 This function provides an efficient way to write to the target memory from a Tcl
5173 script.
5174
5175 @itemize
5176 @item @var{address} ... target memory address
5177 @item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
5178 @item @var{data} ... Tcl list with the elements to write
5179 @item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
5180 @end itemize
5181
5182 For example, the following command writes two 32 bit words into the target
5183 memory at address 0x20000000:
5184
5185 @example
5186 write_memory 0x20000000 32 @{0xdeadbeef 0x00230500@}
5187 @end example
5188 @end deffn
5189
5190 @deffn {Command} {$target_name read_memory} address width count ['phys']
5191 This function provides an efficient way to read the target memory from a Tcl
5192 script.
5193 A Tcl list containing the requested memory elements is returned by this function.
5194
5195 @itemize
5196 @item @var{address} ... target memory address
5197 @item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
5198 @item @var{count} ... number of elements to read
5199 @item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
5200 @end itemize
5201
5202 For example, the following command reads two 32 bit words from the target
5203 memory at address 0x20000000:
5204
5205 @example
5206 read_memory 0x20000000 32 2
5207 @end example
5208 @end deffn
5209
5210 @deffn {Command} {$target_name cget} queryparm
5211 Each configuration parameter accepted by
5212 @command{$target_name configure}
5213 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
5214 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
5215 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
5216 There are a few special cases:
5217
5218 @itemize @bullet
5219 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
5220 event named @var{event_name}.
5221 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
5222 two parameters.
5223 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
5224 This is a special case because this is set using
5225 @command{target create} and can't be changed
5226 using @command{$target_name configure}.
5227 @end itemize
5228
5229 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
5230 all the targets you might use something like this:
5231
5232 @example
5233 foreach name [target names] @{
5234 set y [$name cget -endian]
5235 set z [$name cget -type]
5236 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
5237 $x $name $y $z]
5238 @}
5239 @end example
5240 @end deffn
5241
5242 @anchor{targetcurstate}
5243 @deffn {Command} {$target_name curstate}
5244 Displays the current target state:
5245 @code{debug-running},
5246 @code{halted},
5247 @code{reset},
5248 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
5249 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
5250 @end deffn
5251
5252 @deffn {Command} {$target_name eventlist}
5253 Displays a table listing all event handlers
5254 currently associated with this target.
5255 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
5256 @end deffn
5257
5258 @deffn {Command} {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
5259 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
5260 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
5261 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
5262 @end deffn
5263
5264 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
5265 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
5266 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
5267 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
5268 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5269 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
5270 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5271 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5272 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
5273 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
5274 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
5275 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
5276 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5277 (If you want to process the data instead of displaying it,
5278 see the @code{read_memory} primitives.)
5279 @end deffn
5280
5281 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
5282 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
5283 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
5284 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
5285 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5286 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
5287 at the specified address @var{addr}.
5288 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
5289 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
5290 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
5291 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
5292 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
5293 @end deffn
5294
5295 @anchor{targetevents}
5296 @section Target Events
5297 @cindex target events
5298 @cindex events
5299 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
5300 For example:
5301 @itemize @bullet
5302 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
5303 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
5304 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
5305 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
5306 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
5307 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
5308 to set up system clocks or
5309 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
5310 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
5311 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
5312 @end itemize
5313
5314 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
5315 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
5316 @command{target create ... -event}.
5317
5318 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
5319 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
5320 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
5321
5322 @example
5323 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
5324 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5325 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5326 @}
5327 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
5328 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
5329 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5330 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5331 @}
5332 @end example
5333
5334 The following target events are defined:
5335
5336 @itemize @bullet
5337 @item @b{debug-halted}
5338 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
5339 @item @b{debug-resumed}
5340 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
5341 @item @b{early-halted}
5342 @* Occurs early in the halt process
5343 @item @b{examine-start}
5344 @* Before target examine is called.
5345 @item @b{examine-end}
5346 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
5347 @item @b{examine-fail}
5348 @* After target examine fails.
5349 @item @b{gdb-attach}
5350 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
5351 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
5352 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
5353 connect GDB to running target.
5354 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
5355 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
5356 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
5357 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
5358 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
5359 is in RAM or read only memory.
5360 Default is @code{halt}
5361 @item @b{gdb-detach}
5362 @* When GDB disconnects
5363 @item @b{gdb-end}
5364 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
5365 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
5366 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
5367 @code{reset init})
5368 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
5369 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
5370 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
5371 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
5372 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
5373 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
5374 @item @b{gdb-start}
5375 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
5376 @item @b{halted}
5377 @* The target has halted
5378 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
5379 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5380 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
5381 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
5382 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
5383 @item @b{reset-assert}
5384 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5385 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
5386 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
5387 it instead of asserting SRST.
5388 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
5389 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
5390 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
5391 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
5392 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5393 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
5394 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
5395 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
5396 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5397 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
5398 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
5399 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5400 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
5401 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
5402 released on the scan chain.
5403 @item @b{reset-end}
5404 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
5405 @item @b{reset-init}
5406 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
5407 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
5408
5409 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
5410 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
5411 multiplexing, and so on.
5412 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
5413 the target clocks are fully set up.)
5414 @item @b{reset-start}
5415 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
5416 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
5417
5418 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
5419 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
5420 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
5421 @item @b{resume-start}
5422 @* Before any target is resumed
5423 @item @b{resume-end}
5424 @* After all targets have resumed
5425 @item @b{resumed}
5426 @* Target has resumed
5427 @item @b{step-start}
5428 @* Before a target is single-stepped
5429 @item @b{step-end}
5430 @* After single-step has completed
5431 @item @b{trace-config}
5432 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
5433 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x100}
5434 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x100
5435 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x101}
5436 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x101
5437 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x102}
5438 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x102
5439 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x103}
5440 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x103
5441 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x104}
5442 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x104
5443 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x105}
5444 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x105
5445 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x106}
5446 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x106
5447 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x107}
5448 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x107
5449 @end itemize
5450
5451 @quotation Note
5452 OpenOCD events are not supposed to be preempt by another event, but this
5453 is not enforced in current code. Only the target event @b{resumed} is
5454 executed with polling disabled; this avoids polling to trigger the event
5455 @b{halted}, reversing the logical order of execution of their handlers.
5456 Future versions of OpenOCD will prevent the event preemption and will
5457 disable the schedule of polling during the event execution. Do not rely
5458 on polling in any event handler; this means, don't expect the status of
5459 a core to change during the execution of the handler. The event handler
5460 will have to enable polling or use @command{$target_name arp_poll} to
5461 check if the core has changed status.
5462 @end quotation
5463
5464 @node Flash Commands
5465 @chapter Flash Commands
5466
5467 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
5468 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
5469 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
5470 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
5471 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
5472 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
5473 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
5474 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
5475 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
5476
5477 Flash Steps:
5478 @enumerate
5479 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
5480 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5481 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
5482 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
5483 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5484 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
5485 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
5486 @item GDB Flashing
5487 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
5488 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
5489 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
5490 @end enumerate
5491
5492 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
5493 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
5494 so that it can't boot.
5495 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
5496 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
5497
5498 @anchor{norconfiguration}
5499 @section Flash Configuration Commands
5500 @cindex flash configuration
5501
5502 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
5503 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
5504 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5505 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5506 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5507 see the driver-specific documentation.
5508
5509 @itemize @bullet
5510 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5511 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5512 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5513 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5514 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5515 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5516 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5517 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5518 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5519 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5520 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5521 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5522 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5523 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5524 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5525 commands to the flash controller.
5526 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5527 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5528 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5529 for more information.
5530 @end itemize
5531 @quotation Note
5532 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5533 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5534 @end quotation
5535 @end deffn
5536
5537 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5538 @deffn {Command} {flash banks}
5539 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5540 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5541 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5542 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5543 @end deffn
5544
5545 @deffn {Command} {flash list}
5546 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5547 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5548 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5549 @end deffn
5550
5551 @deffn {Command} {flash probe} num
5552 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5553 depends on the flash type.
5554 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5555 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5556 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5557 but most don't bother.
5558 @end deffn
5559
5560 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5561
5562 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5563 begins.
5564
5565 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5566 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5567 until the programming session is finished.
5568
5569 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5570 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5571
5572 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5573
5574 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5575 @cindex flash erasing
5576 @cindex flash reading
5577 @cindex flash writing
5578 @cindex flash programming
5579 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5580
5581 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5582 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5583 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5584 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5585 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5586
5587 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5588 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5589 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5590 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5591 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5592
5593 @quotation Note
5594 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5595 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5596 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5597 back to a flash bank.
5598 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5599 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5600 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5601 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5602 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5603 @end quotation
5604
5605 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5606 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5607 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5608 disabled first.
5609 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5610 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5611 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5612
5613 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_sector} num first last
5614 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5615 up to and including @var{last}.
5616 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5617 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5618 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5619 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5620 @end deffn
5621
5622 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5623 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5624 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5625 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5626 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5627 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5628 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5629 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5630 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5631 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5632 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5633 before erase starts.
5634 @end deffn
5635
5636 @deffn {Command} {flash filld} address double-word length
5637 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillw} address word length
5638 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillh} address halfword length
5639 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillb} address byte length
5640 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5641 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5642 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5643 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5644 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5645 before issuing this command.
5646 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5647 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5648 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5649 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5650 @end deffn
5651 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5652
5653 @deffn {Command} {flash mdw} addr [count]
5654 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdh} addr [count]
5655 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdb} addr [count]
5656 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5657 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5658 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5659 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5660 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5661 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5662 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5663 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5664 @end deffn
5665
5666 @deffn {Command} {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5667 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5668 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5669 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5670 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5671 @end deffn
5672
5673 @deffn {Command} {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5674 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5675 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5676 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5677 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5678 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5679 @end deffn
5680
5681 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5682 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5683 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5684 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5685 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5686 @end deffn
5687
5688 @deffn {Command} {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5689 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5690 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5691 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5692 to the base address for each section in the image.
5693 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5694 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5695 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5696 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5697 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5698 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5699 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5700 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5701 each image section.
5702
5703 @quotation Warning
5704 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5705 data you want to preserve.
5706 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5707 sections might be erased with no notice.
5708 @itemize
5709 @item
5710 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5711 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5712 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5713 @item
5714 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5715 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5716 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5717 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5718 @end itemize
5719 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5720 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5721 @end quotation
5722
5723 @end deffn
5724
5725 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_image} filename [offset] [type]
5726 Verify the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5727 Parameters follow the description of 'flash write_image'.
5728 In contrast to the 'verify_image' command, for banks with specific
5729 verify method, that one is used instead of the usual target's read
5730 memory methods. This is necessary for flash banks not readable by
5731 ordinary memory reads.
5732 This command gives only an overall good/bad result for each bank, not
5733 addresses of individual failed bytes as it's intended only as quick
5734 check for successful programming.
5735 @end deffn
5736
5737 @section Other Flash commands
5738 @cindex flash protection
5739
5740 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_check} num
5741 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5742 and display that status.
5743 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5744 @end deffn
5745
5746 @deffn {Command} {flash info} num [sectors]
5747 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5748 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5749
5750 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5751 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5752 and possibly stale information.
5753 @end deffn
5754
5755 @anchor{flashprotect}
5756 @deffn {Command} {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5757 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5758 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5759 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5760 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5761 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5762 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5763 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5764 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5765 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5766 @end deffn
5767
5768 @deffn {Command} {flash padded_value} num value
5769 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5770 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5771 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5772 @end deffn
5773
5774 @anchor{program}
5775 @deffn {Command} {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5776 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5777 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5778 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5779 @end deffn
5780
5781 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5782 @section Flash Driver List
5783 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5784 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5785 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5786
5787 @deffn {Flash Driver} {virtual}
5788 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5789 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5790
5791 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5792
5793 @itemize
5794 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5795 @end itemize
5796
5797 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5798 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5799 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5800 @example
5801 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5802 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5803 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5804 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5805 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5806 @end example
5807 @end deffn
5808
5809 @subsection External Flash
5810
5811 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cfi}
5812 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5813 @cindex CFI
5814 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5815 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5816 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5817 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5818 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5819 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5820 configure a bus and its timings), or
5821 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5822 on the flash chip.
5823 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5824 speed up operation.
5825
5826 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5827
5828 @itemize
5829 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5830 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5831 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5832 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5833 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5834 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5835 @end itemize
5836
5837 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5838 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5839
5840 @example
5841 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5842 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5843 @end example
5844
5845 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5846 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5847 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5848
5849 @example
5850 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5851 @end example
5852
5853 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5854 @end deffn
5855
5856 @deffn {Flash Driver} {jtagspi}
5857 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5858 @cindex SPI
5859 @cindex jtagspi
5860 @cindex bscan_spi
5861 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5862 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5863 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5864 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5865 accessed through JTAG.
5866
5867 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5868 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5869 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5870 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5871 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5872 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5873
5874 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5875 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5876 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5877 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5878 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5879 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5880 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5881 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5882
5883 According to device size, 1- to 4-byte addresses are sent. However, some
5884 flash chips additionally have to be switched to 4-byte addresses by an extra
5885 command, see below.
5886
5887 @itemize
5888 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5889 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5890 @var{USER1} instruction.
5891 @end itemize
5892
5893 @example
5894 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5895 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5896 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5897 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5898 @end example
5899
5900 @deffn Command {jtagspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd unused pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5901 Sets flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size}
5902 size in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5903 are commands for read and page program, respectively. @var{mass_erase_cmd},
5904 @var{sector_size} and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5905 @example
5906 jtagspi set 0 w25q128 0x1000000 0x100 0x03 0 0x02 0xC7 0x10000 0xD8
5907 @end example
5908 @end deffn
5909
5910 @deffn Command {jtagspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5911 Sends command @var{cmd_byte} and at most 20 following bytes and reads
5912 @var{resp_num} bytes afterwards. E.g. for 'Enter 4-byte address mode'
5913 @example
5914 jtagspi cmd 0 0 0xB7
5915 @end example
5916 @end deffn
5917
5918 @deffn Command {jtagspi always_4byte} bank_id [ on | off ]
5919 Some devices use 4-byte addresses for all commands except the legacy 0x03 read
5920 regardless of device size. This command controls the corresponding hack.
5921 @end deffn
5922 @end deffn
5923
5924 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xcf}
5925 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5926 @cindex xcf
5927 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5928 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5929 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5930 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5931 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5932
5933 @deffn {Command} {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5934 command accepts additional parameters:
5935 @itemize
5936 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5937 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5938 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5939 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5940 in master mode.
5941 @end itemize
5942 @example
5943 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5944 @end example
5945 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5946 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5947 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5948 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5949 dedicated sector.
5950 @end deffn
5951
5952 @deffn {Command} {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5953 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5954 button.
5955 @example
5956 xcf configure 0
5957 @end example
5958 @end deffn
5959
5960 Additional driver notes:
5961 @itemize
5962 @item Only single revision supported.
5963 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5964 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5965 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5966 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5967 @end itemize
5968 @end deffn
5969
5970 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpcspifi}
5971 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5972 @cindex SPIFI
5973 @cindex lpcspifi
5974 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5975 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5976 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5977
5978 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5979 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5980 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5981 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5982 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5983
5984 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5985 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5986 are configured by the driver.
5987
5988 @example
5989 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5990 @end example
5991
5992 @end deffn
5993
5994 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmsmi}
5995 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5996 @cindex SMI
5997 @cindex stmsmi
5998 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5999 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
6000 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
6001 SPI flash devices.
6002 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
6003 flash devices can be connected.
6004
6005 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
6006 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
6007 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
6008 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
6009 the flash content.
6010
6011 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
6012 to identify the memory bank.
6013 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
6014 flash size, are detected automatically.
6015
6016 @example
6017 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6018 @end example
6019
6020 @end deffn
6021
6022 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmqspi}
6023 @cindex STMicroelectronics QuadSPI/OctoSPI Interface
6024 @cindex QuadSPI
6025 @cindex OctoSPI
6026 @cindex stmqspi
6027 Some devices from STMicroelectronics include a proprietary ``QuadSPI Interface''
6028 (e.g. STM32F4, STM32F7, STM32L4) or ``OctoSPI Interface'' (e.g. STM32L4+)
6029 controller able to drive one or even two (dual mode) external SPI flash devices.
6030 The OctoSPI is a superset of QuadSPI, its presence is detected automatically.
6031 Currently only the regular command mode is supported, whereas the HyperFlash
6032 mode is not.
6033
6034 QuadSPI/OctoSPI makes the flash contents directly accessible in the CPU address
6035 space; in case of dual mode both devices must be of the same type and are
6036 mapped in the same memory bank (even and odd addresses interleaved).
6037 CPU can directly read data, execute code (but not boot) from QuadSPI bank.
6038
6039 The 'flash bank' command only requires the @var{base} parameter and the extra
6040 parameter @var{io_base} in order to identify the memory bank. Both are fixed
6041 by hardware, see datasheet or RM. All other parameters are ignored.
6042
6043 The controller must be initialized after each reset and properly configured
6044 for memory-mapped read operation for the particular flash chip(s), for the full
6045 list of available register settings cf. the controller's RM. This setup is quite
6046 board specific (that's why booting from this memory is not possible). The
6047 flash driver infers all parameters from current controller register values when
6048 'flash probe @var{bank_id}' is executed.
6049
6050 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display the flash content,
6051 but only after proper controller initialization as described above. However,
6052 due to a silicon bug in some devices, attempting to access the very last word
6053 should be avoided.
6054
6055 It is possible to use two (even different) flash chips alternatingly, if individual
6056 bank chip selects are available. For some package variants, this is not the case
6057 due to limited pin count. To switch from one to another, adjust FSEL bit accordingly
6058 and re-issue 'flash probe bank_id'. Note that the bank base address will @emph{not}
6059 change, so the address spaces of both devices will overlap. In dual flash mode
6060 both chips must be identical regarding size and most other properties.
6061
6062 Block or sector protection internal to the flash chip is not handled by this
6063 driver at all, but can be dealt with manually by the 'cmd' command, see below.
6064 The sector protection via 'flash protect' command etc. is completely internal to
6065 openocd, intended only to prevent accidental erase or overwrite and it does not
6066 persist across openocd invocations.
6067
6068 OpenOCD contains a hardcoded list of flash devices with their properties,
6069 these are auto-detected. If a device is not included in this list, SFDP discovery
6070 is attempted. If this fails or gives inappropriate results, manual setting is
6071 required (see 'set' command).
6072
6073 @example
6074 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x90000000 0 0 0 \
6075 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001000
6076 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x70000000 0 0 0 \
6077 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001400
6078 @end example
6079
6080 There are three specific commands
6081 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi mass_erase} bank_id
6082 Clears sector protections and performs a mass erase. Works only if there is no
6083 chip specific write protection engaged.
6084 @end deffn
6085
6086 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd fread_cmd pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
6087 Set flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size} size
6088 in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd}, @var{fread_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
6089 are commands for reading and page programming. @var{fread_cmd} is used in DPI and QPI modes,
6090 @var{read_cmd} in normal SPI (single line) mode. @var{mass_erase_cmd}, @var{sector_size}
6091 and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
6092
6093 This command is required if chip id is not hardcoded yet and e.g. for EEPROMs or FRAMs
6094 which don't support an id command.
6095
6096 In dual mode parameters of both chips are set identically. The parameters refer to
6097 a single chip, so the whole bank gets twice the specified capacity etc.
6098 @end deffn
6099
6100 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
6101 If @var{resp_num} is zero, sends command @var{cmd_byte} and following data
6102 bytes. In dual mode command byte is sent to @emph{both} chips but data bytes are
6103 sent @emph{alternatingly} to chip 1 and 2, first to flash 1, second to flash 2, etc.,
6104 i.e. the total number of bytes (including cmd_byte) must be odd.
6105
6106 If @var{resp_num} is not zero, cmd and at most four following data bytes are
6107 sent, in dual mode @emph{simultaneously} to both chips. Then @var{resp_num} bytes
6108 are read interleaved from both chips starting with chip 1. In this case
6109 @var{resp_num} must be even.
6110
6111 Note the hardware dictated subtle difference of those two cases in dual-flash mode.
6112
6113 To check basic communication settings, issue
6114 @example
6115 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
6116 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
6117 @end example
6118 for single flash mode or
6119 @example
6120 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
6121 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
6122 @end example
6123 for dual flash mode. This should return the status register contents.
6124
6125 In 8-line mode, @var{cmd_byte} is sent twice - first time as given, second time
6126 complemented. Additionally, in 8-line mode only, some commands (e.g. Read Status)
6127 need a dummy address, e.g.
6128 @example
6129 stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
6130 @end example
6131 should return the status register contents.
6132
6133 @end deffn
6134
6135 @end deffn
6136
6137 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mrvlqspi}
6138 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
6139 Microcontroller platform.
6140
6141 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
6142 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
6143
6144 @example
6145 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
6146 @end example
6147
6148 @end deffn
6149
6150 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ath79}
6151 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
6152 @cindex ath79
6153 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
6154 chip selects.
6155 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
6156 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
6157 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
6158 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
6159 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
6160 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
6161
6162 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
6163 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
6164 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
6165 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
6166 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
6167 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
6168 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
6169 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
6170 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
6171 with the default CS0.
6172 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
6173 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
6174 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
6175
6176 @example
6177 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6178
6179 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different
6180 # for each, otherwise the write_image command is not able to
6181 # distinguish the banks.
6182 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
6183 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
6184 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
6185 @end example
6186
6187 @end deffn
6188
6189 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fespi}
6190 @cindex Freedom E SPI
6191 @cindex fespi
6192
6193 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
6194
6195 @example
6196 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6197 @end example
6198 @end deffn
6199
6200 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
6201
6202 @deffn {Flash Driver} {aduc702x}
6203 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
6204 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6205 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
6206 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
6207 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
6208
6209 @example
6210 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6211 @end example
6212 @end deffn
6213
6214 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ambiqmicro}
6215 @cindex ambiqmicro
6216 @cindex apollo
6217 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
6218 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6219 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
6220 with the target using SWD.
6221
6222 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
6223 the device class of the MCU.
6224 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
6225 to set up the flash banks.
6226 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
6227 sizes of an Apollo chip.
6228
6229 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
6230 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
6231 and the second bank starts after the first.
6232
6233 @example
6234 # Flash bank 0
6235 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6236 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
6237 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
6238 $_TARGETNAME
6239 @end example
6240
6241 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
6242 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
6243 are available to the user.
6244
6245 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
6246
6247 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
6248 Erase entire bank.
6249 @end deffn
6250 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
6251 Erase device pages.
6252 @end deffn
6253 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
6254 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
6255 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
6256 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
6257 the flash.
6258 @end deffn
6259 @end deffn
6260
6261 @anchor{at91samd}
6262 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91samd}
6263 @cindex at91samd
6264 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
6265 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
6266
6267 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
6268
6269 The devices have one flash bank:
6270
6271 @example
6272 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6273 @end example
6274
6275 @deffn {Command} {at91samd chip-erase}
6276 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6277 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6278 processor to be halted.
6279 @end deffn
6280
6281 @deffn {Command} {at91samd set-security}
6282 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
6283 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
6284 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
6285 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
6286 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
6287
6288 @example
6289 at91samd set-security enable
6290 @end example
6291 @end deffn
6292
6293 @deffn {Command} {at91samd eeprom}
6294 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
6295 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
6296 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
6297 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
6298 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
6299 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
6300 in order to disable this feature.
6301
6302 @example
6303 at91samd eeprom
6304 at91samd eeprom 1024
6305 @end example
6306 @end deffn
6307
6308 @deffn {Command} {at91samd bootloader}
6309 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
6310 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6311 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
6312 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
6313 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6314
6315 @example
6316 at91samd bootloader
6317 at91samd bootloader 16384
6318 @end example
6319 @end deffn
6320
6321 @deffn {Command} {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
6322 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6323 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6324 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6325 @end deffn
6326
6327 @deffn {Command} {at91samd nvmuserrow}
6328 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
6329 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
6330 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
6331 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6332 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
6333 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
6334 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
6335
6336 @example
6337 # Read user row
6338 >at91samd nvmuserrow
6339 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6340 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
6341 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6342 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low
6343 # byte unchanged
6344 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
6345 @end example
6346 @end deffn
6347
6348 @end deffn
6349
6350 @anchor{at91sam3}
6351 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam3}
6352 @cindex at91sam3
6353 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
6354 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
6355 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
6356 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
6357 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
6358 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
6359 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
6360 chips are confirmed.}
6361
6362 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
6363 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
6364 the following fixed locations:
6365
6366 @example
6367 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
6368 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6369 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
6370 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6371 @end example
6372
6373 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
6374 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
6375 to the @command{flash bank} command:
6376
6377 @itemize
6378 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
6379 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
6380 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
6381 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
6382 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
6383 @end itemize
6384
6385 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
6386
6387 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm}
6388 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
6389 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
6390 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
6391 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
6392 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
6393 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
6394
6395 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
6396 modifies that GPNVM bit.
6397 @end deffn
6398
6399 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 info}
6400 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
6401 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
6402 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
6403 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
6404 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
6405 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
6406 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
6407 @end deffn
6408
6409 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
6410 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
6411 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
6412 @end deffn
6413 @end deffn
6414
6415 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4}
6416 @cindex at91sam4
6417 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
6418 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6419 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6420 @end deffn
6421
6422 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4l}
6423 @cindex at91sam4l
6424 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
6425 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6426 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6427
6428 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
6429 @deffn {Command} {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
6430 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
6431 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6432 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6433 @end deffn
6434 @end deffn
6435
6436 @anchor{atsame5}
6437 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsame5}
6438 @cindex atsame5
6439 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
6440 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
6441 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6442
6443 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
6444 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
6445 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
6446
6447 @example
6448 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6449 @end example
6450
6451 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 bootloader}
6452 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
6453 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6454 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
6455 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
6456 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6457
6458 @example
6459 atsame5 bootloader
6460 atsame5 bootloader 16384
6461 @end example
6462 @end deffn
6463
6464 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 chip-erase}
6465 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6466 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6467 processor to be halted.
6468 @end deffn
6469
6470 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
6471 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6472 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6473 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6474 @end deffn
6475
6476 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 userpage}
6477 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
6478 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
6479 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
6480 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6481 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
6482 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
6483 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
6484
6485 @example
6486 # Read
6487 >atsame5 userpage
6488 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6489 # Write
6490 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6491 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other
6492 # bits unchanged (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192
6493 # bytes)
6494 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
6495 @end example
6496 @end deffn
6497
6498 @end deffn
6499
6500 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsamv}
6501 @cindex atsamv
6502 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
6503 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
6504 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6505
6506 @example
6507 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsamv 0x00400000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6508 @end example
6509
6510 @deffn {Command} {atsamv gpnvm} [@option{show} [@option{all}|number]]
6511 @deffnx {Command} {atsamv gpnvm} (@option{clr}|@option{set}) number
6512 With no parameters, @option{show} or @option{show all},
6513 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
6514 With @option{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
6515
6516 With @option{set} @var{number} or @option{clear} @var{number},
6517 modifies that GPNVM bit.
6518 @end deffn
6519
6520 @end deffn
6521
6522 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam7}
6523 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
6524 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
6525 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
6526 register, and autoconfigures itself.
6527
6528 @example
6529 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6530 @end example
6531
6532 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
6533 provide additional parameters in the following order:
6534
6535 @itemize
6536 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
6537 @item @var{banks}
6538 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
6539 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
6540 @item @var{pages_size}
6541 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
6542 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
6543 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
6544 @end itemize
6545
6546 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
6547 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
6548 will be autoconfigured.
6549 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
6550
6551 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
6552 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
6553 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
6554 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
6555 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
6556
6557 @deffn {Command} {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
6558 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
6559 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
6560 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
6561 are not truly general purpose).
6562 @quotation Note
6563 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
6564 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
6565 @end quotation
6566 @end deffn
6567 @end deffn
6568
6569 @deffn {Flash Driver} {avr}
6570 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
6571 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
6572 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6573 @end deffn
6574
6575 @deffn {Flash Driver} {bluenrg-x}
6576 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP/LPS Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
6577 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
6578 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
6579
6580 @example
6581 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6582 @end example
6583
6584 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
6585 each single sector one by one.
6586
6587 @example
6588 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
6589 @end example
6590
6591 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
6592 @end deffn
6593
6594 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc26xx}
6595 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
6596 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
6597 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
6598 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
6599 starts at address 0.
6600
6601 @example
6602 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6603 @end example
6604 @end deffn
6605
6606 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc3220sf}
6607 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
6608 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
6609 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
6610 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
6611 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
6612 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
6613 and programming the serial flash.
6614
6615 @example
6616 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6617 @end example
6618 @end deffn
6619
6620 @deffn {Flash Driver} {efm32}
6621 All members of the EFM32/EFR32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro (now Silicon Labs)
6622 include internal flash and use Arm Cortex-M3 or Cortex-M4 cores. The driver automatically
6623 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
6624 autoconfigures itself.
6625 @example
6626 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6627 @end example
6628 It supports writing to the user data page, as well as the portion of the lockbits page
6629 past 512 bytes on chips with larger page sizes. The latter is used by the SiLabs
6630 bootloader/AppLoader system for encryption keys. Setting protection on these pages is
6631 currently not supported.
6632 @example
6633 flash bank userdata.flash efm32 0x0FE00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6634 flash bank lockbits.flash efm32 0x0FE04000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6635 @end example
6636
6637 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
6638 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
6639 this via the following command:
6640 @example
6641 efm32 debuglock num
6642 @end example
6643 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6644 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
6645 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
6646 supported.}
6647 @end deffn
6648
6649 @deffn {Flash Driver} {esirisc}
6650 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
6651 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
6652 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
6653 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
6654 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
6655
6656 @example
6657 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
6658 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
6659 @end example
6660
6661 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
6662 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
6663 @end deffn
6664
6665 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
6666 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
6667 is an uncommon operation.}
6668 @end deffn
6669 @end deffn
6670
6671 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm3}
6672 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
6673 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6674 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6675 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6676 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
6677 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
6678
6679 @example
6680 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6681 @end example
6682 @end deffn
6683
6684 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm4}
6685 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6686 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6687 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6688 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6689 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6690 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6691 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6692 characters) ignored.
6693
6694 @example
6695 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6696 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6697 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6698 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6699 @end example
6700 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6701 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6702 @end deffn
6703
6704 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis}
6705 @cindex kinetis
6706 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6707 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6708 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6709 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6710 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6711 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6712
6713 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6714 @itemize
6715 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6716 @end itemize
6717
6718 @example
6719 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6720 @end example
6721
6722 @deffn {Config Command} {kinetis create_banks}
6723 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6724 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6725 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6726 @end deffn
6727
6728 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6729 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6730 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6731 set by 'flash protect' command.
6732 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6733 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6734 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6735 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6736 with the rest of a flash image.
6737 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6738 @end deffn
6739
6740 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fopt} [num]
6741 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6742 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6743 @end deffn
6744
6745 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm check_security}
6746 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6747 and examine-fail event.
6748 @end deffn
6749
6750 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm halt}
6751 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6752 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6753 @end deffn
6754
6755 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6756 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6757 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6758 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6759 command completes.
6760 @end deffn
6761
6762 @deffn {Command} {kinetis nvm_partition}
6763 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6764 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6765 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6766 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6767
6768 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6769 Program Partition command.
6770
6771 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6772 Reset the device after partition setting.
6773
6774 Show partition size:
6775 @example
6776 kinetis nvm_partition info
6777 @end example
6778
6779 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6780 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6781 @example
6782 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6783 @end example
6784
6785 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6786 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6787 @example
6788 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6789 @end example
6790 @end deffn
6791
6792 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm reset}
6793 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6794 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6795 @end deffn
6796
6797 @deffn {Command} {kinetis disable_wdog}
6798 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6799 Command disables watchdog timer.
6800 @end deffn
6801 @end deffn
6802
6803 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis_ke}
6804 @cindex kinetis_ke
6805 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6806 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6807 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6808 autoconfigures itself.
6809 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6810
6811 @example
6812 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6813 @end example
6814
6815 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6816 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6817 @end deffn
6818
6819 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6820 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6821 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6822 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6823 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6824 @end deffn
6825
6826 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6827 Command disables watchdog timer.
6828 @end deffn
6829 @end deffn
6830
6831 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2000}
6832 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6833 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6834 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6835 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6836
6837 @quotation Note
6838 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6839 driver:
6840 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6841 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6842 @end quotation
6843
6844 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6845 which must appear in the following order:
6846
6847 @itemize
6848 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6849 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6850 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6851 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6852 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6853 LPC43x[2357])
6854 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6855 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6856 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6857 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6858 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6859 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6860 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6861 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6862 at which the core is running
6863 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6864 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6865 @quotation Note
6866 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6867 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6868 However, if you do provide it,
6869 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6870 @end quotation
6871 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6872 ROM IAP entry point.
6873 @end itemize
6874
6875 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6876
6877 @example
6878 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6879 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6880 @end example
6881
6882 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6883 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6884 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6885 @end deffn
6886 @end deffn
6887
6888 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc288x}
6889 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6890 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6891 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6892 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6893 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6894
6895 @example
6896 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6897 @end example
6898 @end deffn
6899
6900 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2900}
6901 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6902 from NXP.
6903
6904 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6905 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6906 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6907 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6908 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6909 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6910 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6911 you start the PLL.
6912
6913 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6914
6915 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6916 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6917 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6918
6919 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6920 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6921 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6922 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6923 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6924 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6925 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6926
6927 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6928 @example
6929 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6930 @end example
6931
6932 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6933 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6934 @code{flash banks} command.
6935
6936 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 signature} bank
6937 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6938 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6939 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6940 a known signature.
6941 Example:
6942 @example
6943 lpc2900 signature 0
6944 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6945 @end example
6946 @end deffn
6947
6948 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6949 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6950 saves it to a file in binary format.
6951 Example:
6952 @example
6953 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6954 @end example
6955 @end deffn
6956
6957 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6958 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6959 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6960 command:
6961
6962 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 password} bank password
6963 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6964 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6965 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6966
6967 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6968 Example:
6969 @example
6970 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6971 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6972 @end example
6973 @end deffn
6974
6975 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6976 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6977 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6978 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6979 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6980 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6981 912 bytes.
6982 @quotation Attention
6983 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6984 @end quotation
6985 Example:
6986 @example
6987 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6988 @end example
6989 @end deffn
6990
6991 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6992 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6993 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6994 after the next power cycle.
6995 @quotation Attention
6996 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6997 @end quotation
6998 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6999 Example:
7000 @example
7001 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
7002 flash info 0
7003 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
7004 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
7005 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
7006 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
7007 @end example
7008 @end deffn
7009
7010 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
7011 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
7012 effective after the next power cycle.
7013 @quotation Attention
7014 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
7015 @end quotation
7016 Examples:
7017 @example
7018 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
7019 @end example
7020 @end deffn
7021 @end deffn
7022
7023 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mdr}
7024 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
7025 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
7026 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
7027
7028 @example
7029 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
7030 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
7031 @end example
7032
7033 @itemize @bullet
7034 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
7035 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
7036 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
7037 @end itemize
7038
7039 Example usage:
7040 @example
7041 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
7042 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
7043 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
7044 @} else @{
7045 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
7046 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
7047 @}
7048 @end example
7049 @end deffn
7050
7051 @deffn {Flash Driver} {msp432}
7052 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
7053 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
7054 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
7055 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
7056 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
7057
7058 @example
7059 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7060 @end example
7061
7062 @deffn {Command} {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
7063 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
7064 only the main program flash.
7065
7066 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
7067 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
7068 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
7069 @end deffn
7070
7071 @deffn {Command} {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
7072 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
7073 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
7074 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
7075
7076 To erase and program the BSL:
7077 @example
7078 msp432 bsl unlock
7079 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
7080 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
7081 msp432 bsl lock
7082 @end example
7083 @end deffn
7084 @end deffn
7085
7086 @deffn {Flash Driver} {niietcm4}
7087 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
7088 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
7089 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
7090 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
7091 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
7092 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
7093 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
7094 also have division into regions: main and info.
7095 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
7096 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
7097
7098 @example
7099 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7100 @end example
7101
7102 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
7103
7104 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
7105 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
7106 @end deffn
7107
7108 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
7109 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
7110 @end deffn
7111
7112 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
7113 Erase all userflash including info region.
7114 @end deffn
7115
7116 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
7117 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
7118 @end deffn
7119
7120 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
7121 Check sectors protect.
7122 @end deffn
7123
7124 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
7125 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
7126 @end deffn
7127
7128 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
7129 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
7130 @end deffn
7131
7132 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
7133 Configure external memory interface for boot.
7134 @end deffn
7135
7136 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
7137 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
7138 @end deffn
7139
7140 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
7141 Show information about flash driver.
7142 @end deffn
7143
7144 @end deffn
7145
7146 @deffn {Flash Driver} {npcx}
7147 All versions of the NPCX microcontroller families from Nuvoton include internal
7148 flash. The NPCX flash driver supports the NPCX family of devices. The driver
7149 automatically recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and
7150 autoconfigures itself. The flash bank starts at address 0x64000000.
7151
7152 @example
7153 flash bank $_FLASHNAME npcx 0x64000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7154 @end example
7155 @end deffn
7156
7157 @deffn {Flash Driver} {nrf5}
7158 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
7159 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core. nRF52 family powered
7160 by ARM Cortex-M4 or M4F core is supported too. nRF52832 is fully supported
7161 including BPROT flash protection scheme. nRF52833 and nRF52840 devices are
7162 supported with the exception of security extensions (flash access control list
7163 - ACL).
7164
7165 @example
7166 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7167 @end example
7168
7169 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
7170
7171 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 mass_erase}
7172 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
7173 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
7174 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
7175 code.
7176 @end deffn
7177
7178 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 info}
7179 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
7180 @end deffn
7181
7182 @end deffn
7183
7184 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ocl}
7185 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
7186 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
7187
7188 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
7189 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
7190 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
7191 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
7192
7193 @example
7194 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7195 @end example
7196 @end deffn
7197
7198 @deffn {Flash Driver} {pic32mx}
7199 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
7200 and integrate flash memory.
7201
7202 @example
7203 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7204 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7205 @end example
7206
7207 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
7208 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
7209 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
7210 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
7211 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
7212 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
7213 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
7214 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
7215 @end deffn
7216 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx unlock} bank
7217 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
7218 This will remove any Code Protection.
7219 @end deffn
7220 @end deffn
7221
7222 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc4}
7223 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
7224 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
7225 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7226 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7227
7228 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
7229 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
7230
7231 @example
7232 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7233 @end example
7234
7235 psoc4-specific commands
7236 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
7237 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
7238
7239 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
7240 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
7241
7242 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
7243 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
7244 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
7245
7246 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7247 @end deffn
7248
7249 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 mass_erase} num
7250 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
7251
7252 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7253 @end deffn
7254 @end deffn
7255
7256 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp}
7257 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
7258 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
7259 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
7260 apart from the base address.
7261
7262 @example
7263 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7264 @end example
7265
7266 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
7267 @quotation Attention
7268 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
7269 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
7270 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
7271 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
7272 @end quotation
7273
7274 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
7275
7276 @deffn {Command} {psoc5lp mass_erase}
7277 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
7278 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
7279 @end deffn
7280 @end deffn
7281
7282 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_eeprom}
7283 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
7284 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
7285 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
7286 apart from the base address.
7287
7288 @example
7289 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 \
7290 $_TARGETNAME
7291 @end example
7292 @end deffn
7293
7294 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_nvl}
7295 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
7296 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
7297 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
7298
7299 @example
7300 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7301 @end example
7302
7303 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
7304
7305 @itemize
7306 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
7307 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
7308 @end itemize
7309
7310 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
7311
7312 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
7313 @quotation Attention
7314 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
7315 after successful write.
7316 @end quotation
7317 @end deffn
7318
7319 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc6}
7320 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
7321 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
7322 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
7323
7324 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
7325 @itemize @bullet
7326 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
7327 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
7328 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
7329 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
7330 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
7331 row size: 512 bytes.
7332 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
7333 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
7334 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
7335 operation will erase row automatically.
7336 @end itemize
7337
7338 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
7339 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
7340
7341 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
7342
7343 @example
7344 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7345 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7346 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7347 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7348 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7349 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7350 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7351 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7352 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7353 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7354 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7355 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7356
7357 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7358 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7359 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7360 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7361 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7362 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7363 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7364 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7365 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7366 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7367 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7368 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7369 @end example
7370
7371 psoc6-specific commands
7372 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 reset_halt}
7373 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
7374 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
7375 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
7376 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
7377 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
7378 @end deffn
7379
7380 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 mass_erase} num
7381 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
7382 by @command{flash banks}.
7383 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
7384 @end deffn
7385 @end deffn
7386
7387 @deffn {Flash Driver} {rp2040}
7388 Supports RP2040 "Raspberry Pi Pico" microcontroller.
7389 RP2040 is a dual-core device with two CM0+ cores. Both cores share the same
7390 Flash/RAM/MMIO address space. Non-volatile storage is achieved with an
7391 external QSPI flash; a Boot ROM provides helper functions.
7392
7393 @example
7394 flash bank $_FLASHNAME rp2040_flash $_FLASHBASE $_FLASHSIZE 1 32 $_TARGETNAME
7395 @end example
7396 @end deffn
7397
7398 @deffn {Flash Driver} {sim3x}
7399 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
7400 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
7401 and SWD interface.
7402 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
7403 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
7404
7405 @example
7406 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7407 @end example
7408
7409 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
7410
7411 @deffn {Command} {sim3x mass_erase}
7412 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
7413 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
7414 @end deffn
7415
7416 @deffn {Command} {sim3x lock}
7417 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
7418 @end deffn
7419 @end deffn
7420
7421 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stellaris}
7422 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
7423 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
7424 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
7425 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7426
7427 @example
7428 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7429 @end example
7430
7431 @deffn {Command} {stellaris recover}
7432 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
7433 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
7434 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
7435 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
7436 disabled.
7437
7438 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
7439 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
7440 @quotation Warning
7441 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
7442 applied to all of them.
7443 @end quotation
7444 @end deffn
7445 @end deffn
7446
7447 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f1x}
7448 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
7449 from STMicroelectronics and all members of the GD32F1x0, GD32F3x0 and GD32E23x microcontroller
7450 families from GigaDevice include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4/M23 cores.
7451 The driver also works with GD32VF103 powered by RISC-V core.
7452 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7453 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7454
7455 @example
7456 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7457 @end example
7458
7459 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7460 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7461 the flash driver.
7462
7463 @example
7464 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7465 @end example
7466
7467 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
7468 as per the following example.
7469 @example
7470 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7471 @end example
7472
7473 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
7474
7475 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x lock} num
7476 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
7477 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7478 @end deffn
7479
7480 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x unlock} num
7481 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
7482 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
7483 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7484 @end deffn
7485
7486 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
7487 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
7488 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7489 @end deffn
7490
7491 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_read} num
7492 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
7493 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
7494 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7495 @end deffn
7496
7497 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
7498 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
7499 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7500 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
7501 @end deffn
7502
7503 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_load} num
7504 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
7505 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
7506 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
7507 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7508 @end deffn
7509 @end deffn
7510
7511 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f2x}
7512 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7513 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
7514 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7515 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7516
7517 @example
7518 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7519 @end example
7520
7521 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7522 as per the following example.
7523 @example
7524 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7525 @end example
7526
7527 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7528 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7529 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7530 @end deffn
7531
7532 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7533 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7534 the flash driver.
7535
7536 @example
7537 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7538 @end example
7539
7540 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
7541
7542 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x lock} num
7543 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7544 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7545 @end deffn
7546
7547 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x unlock} num
7548 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7549 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7550 @end deffn
7551
7552 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
7553 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
7554 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7555 @end deffn
7556
7557 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_read} num
7558 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
7559 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7560 @end deffn
7561
7562 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
7563 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
7564 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
7565 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
7566 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
7567 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
7568 @end deffn
7569
7570 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
7571 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
7572 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
7573 @end deffn
7574 @end deffn
7575
7576 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32h7x}
7577 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7578 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
7579 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7580 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7581
7582 @example
7583 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7584 @end example
7585
7586 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7587 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7588 the flash driver.
7589
7590 @example
7591 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7592 @end example
7593
7594 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
7595
7596 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x lock} num
7597 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7598 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7599 @end deffn
7600
7601 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x unlock} num
7602 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7603 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7604 @end deffn
7605
7606 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
7607 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
7608 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7609 @end deffn
7610
7611 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
7612 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
7613 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7614 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
7615 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
7616
7617 Example usage:
7618 @example
7619 # read OPTSR_CUR
7620 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
7621 # read WPSN_CUR1R
7622 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
7623 # read WPSN_CUR2R
7624 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
7625 @end example
7626 @end deffn
7627
7628 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
7629 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
7630 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7631 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
7632 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
7633 will be touched).
7634
7635 Example usage:
7636 @example
7637 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices
7638 # by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
7639 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
7640 @end example
7641 @end deffn
7642 @end deffn
7643
7644 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32lx}
7645 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7646 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
7647 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7648 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7649
7650 @example
7651 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7652 @end example
7653
7654 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7655 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7656 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
7657 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
7658 second bank.
7659
7660 @example
7661 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7662 @end example
7663
7664 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
7665
7666 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx lock} num
7667 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7668 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7669 @end deffn
7670
7671 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx unlock} num
7672 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7673 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7674 @end deffn
7675
7676 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx mass_erase} num
7677 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
7678 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
7679 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
7680 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7681 @end deffn
7682 @end deffn
7683
7684 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32l4x}
7685 All members of the STM32 G0, G4, L4, L4+, L5, U5, WB and WL
7686 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
7687 and use ARM Cortex-M0+, M4 and M33 cores.
7688 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7689 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7690
7691 @example
7692 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7693 @end example
7694
7695 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7696 as per the following example.
7697 @example
7698 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x1FFF7000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7699 @end example
7700
7701 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7702 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7703 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7704 @end deffn
7705
7706 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7707 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7708 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
7709 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
7710
7711 @example
7712 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7713 @end example
7714
7715 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
7716
7717 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x lock} num
7718 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7719 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7720
7721 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7722 @end deffn
7723
7724 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x unlock} num
7725 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7726 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7727
7728 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7729 @end deffn
7730
7731 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
7732 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
7733 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7734 @end deffn
7735
7736 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
7737 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
7738 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7739 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7740
7741 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7742 @example
7743 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7744 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7745 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7746 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7747 @end example
7748
7749 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7750 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7751 @end deffn
7752
7753 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7754 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7755 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7756 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7757 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7758
7759 @emph{Note:} To apply the option bytes change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7760
7761 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7762 @example
7763 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7764 @end example
7765
7766 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7767 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7768 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7769 @end deffn
7770
7771 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x wrp_info} num [device_bank]
7772 List the protected areas using WRP.
7773 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7774 @var{device_bank} parameter is optional, possible values 'bank1' or 'bank2',
7775 if not specified, the command will display the whole flash protected areas.
7776
7777 @b{Note:} @var{device_bank} is different from banks created using @code{flash bank}.
7778 Devices supported in this flash driver, can have main flash memory organized
7779 in single or dual-banks mode.
7780 Thus the usage of @var{device_bank} is meaningful only in dual-bank mode, to get
7781 write protected areas in a specific @var{device_bank}
7782
7783 @end deffn
7784
7785 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_load} num
7786 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
7787 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7788 @end deffn
7789
7790 @deffn Command {stm32l4x trustzone} num [@option{enable} | @option{disable}]
7791 Enables or disables Global TrustZone Security, using the TZEN option bit.
7792 If neither @option{enabled} nor @option{disable} are specified, the command will display
7793 the TrustZone status.
7794 @emph{Note:} This command works only with devices with TrustZone, eg. STM32L5.
7795 @emph{Note:} This command will perform an OBL_Launch after modifying the TZEN.
7796 @end deffn
7797 @end deffn
7798
7799 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str7x}
7800 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7801 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7802 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7803 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7804
7805 @example
7806 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7807 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7808 @end example
7809
7810 @deffn {Command} {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7811 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7812 for the specified flash bank.
7813 @end deffn
7814 @end deffn
7815
7816 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9x}
7817 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7818 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7819 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7820 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7821
7822 @example
7823 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7824 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7825 @end example
7826
7827 @deffn {Command} {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7828 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7829 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7830
7831 @itemize @bullet
7832 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7833 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7834 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7835 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7836 @end itemize
7837 @end deffn
7838
7839 @end deffn
7840
7841 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9xpec}
7842 @cindex str9xpec
7843
7844 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7845 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7846 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7847 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7848
7849 Here is some background info to help
7850 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7851 the str9:
7852 @enumerate
7853 @item
7854 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7855 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7856 @item
7857 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7858 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7859 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7860 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7861 @end enumerate
7862
7863 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7864 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7865 configured for flash bank 0.
7866 @example
7867 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7868 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7869 adapter assert srst
7870 # turn off target polling
7871 poll off
7872 # disable str9 core
7873 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7874 # read option bytes
7875 str9xpec options_read 0
7876 # re-enable str9 core
7877 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7878 poll on
7879 reset halt
7880 @end example
7881 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7882 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7883 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7884 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7885
7886 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7887
7888 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7889 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7890 @end deffn
7891
7892 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7893 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7894 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7895 @end deffn
7896
7897 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec lock} num
7898 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7899 erase the device.
7900 @end deffn
7901
7902 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec part_id} num
7903 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7904 @end deffn
7905
7906 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7907 Configure str9 boot bank.
7908 @end deffn
7909
7910 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7911 Configure str9 lvd source.
7912 @end deffn
7913
7914 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7915 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7916 @end deffn
7917
7918 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7919 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7920 @end deffn
7921
7922 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_read} num
7923 Read str9 option bytes.
7924 @end deffn
7925
7926 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_write} num
7927 Write str9 option bytes.
7928 @end deffn
7929
7930 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec unlock} num
7931 unlock str9 device.
7932 @end deffn
7933
7934 @end deffn
7935
7936 @deffn {Flash Driver} {swm050}
7937 @cindex swm050
7938 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7939
7940 @example
7941 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7942 @end example
7943
7944 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7945
7946 @deffn {Command} {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7947 Erases the entire flash bank.
7948 @end deffn
7949
7950 @end deffn
7951
7952
7953 @deffn {Flash Driver} {tms470}
7954 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7955 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7956 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7957
7958 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7959
7960 @deffn {Command} {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7961 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7962 @end deffn
7963
7964 @deffn {Command} {tms470 osc_megahertz} clock_mhz
7965 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7966 @end deffn
7967
7968 @deffn {Command} {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7969 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7970 the flash clock.
7971 @end deffn
7972 @end deffn
7973
7974 @deffn {Flash Driver} {w600}
7975 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7976 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7977 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7978 correct bank config.
7979
7980 @example
7981 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7982 @end example
7983 @end deffn
7984
7985 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc1xxx}
7986 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7987 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7988 @end deffn
7989
7990 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc4xxx}
7991 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7992 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7993
7994 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7995
7996 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7997 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7998 @end deffn
7999
8000 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
8001 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
8002 @end deffn
8003
8004 @end deffn
8005
8006 @section NAND Flash Commands
8007 @cindex NAND
8008
8009 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
8010 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
8011 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
8012
8013 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
8014 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
8015 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
8016 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
8017 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
8018 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
8019
8020 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
8021 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
8022 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
8023 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
8024 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
8025 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
8026 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
8027 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
8028 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
8029 with techniques such as wear leveling.
8030
8031 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
8032 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
8033 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
8034 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
8035 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
8036 every 512 bytes of data.
8037
8038 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
8039 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
8040 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
8041 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
8042 ECC mode is used.
8043
8044 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
8045 @enumerate
8046 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
8047 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
8048 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
8049 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
8050 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
8051 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
8052 to access that device.
8053 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
8054 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
8055 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
8056 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
8057 de-brick a board.
8058 @end enumerate
8059
8060 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
8061 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
8062 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
8063 are only 32 bits wide.
8064 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
8065 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
8066 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
8067 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
8068
8069 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
8070 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
8071 @cindex NAND configuration
8072
8073 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
8074 plus some additional configuration that's done after
8075 OpenOCD has initialized.
8076
8077 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
8078 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
8079 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
8080 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
8081 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
8082 they were a single (larger) device.
8083 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
8084 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
8085
8086 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
8087 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
8088 configuration files, not interactively.
8089
8090 @itemize @bullet
8091 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
8092 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
8093 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
8094 associated with the NAND device being declared.
8095 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
8096 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
8097 commands to the NAND controller.
8098 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
8099 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
8100 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
8101 for more information.
8102 @end itemize
8103 @end deffn
8104
8105 @deffn {Command} {nand list}
8106 Prints a summary of each device declared
8107 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
8108 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
8109 @example
8110 > nand list
8111 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
8112 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
8113 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
8114 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
8115 >
8116 @end example
8117 @end deffn
8118
8119 @deffn {Command} {nand probe} num
8120 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
8121 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
8122 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8123 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
8124 it with most other NAND commands.
8125 @end deffn
8126
8127 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
8128
8129 @deffn {Command} {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
8130 @cindex NAND reading
8131 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
8132 starting at the specified offset.
8133 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8134
8135 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
8136 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
8137
8138 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
8139 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
8140 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
8141
8142 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
8143 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
8144 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
8145 method which handled that error correction.
8146
8147 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
8148 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
8149 @itemize @bullet
8150 @item no oob_* parameter
8151 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
8152 @item @code{oob_raw}
8153 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
8154 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
8155 spare areas associated with each data page.
8156 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
8157 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
8158 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
8159 @item @code{oob_only}
8160 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
8161 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
8162 spare areas associated with each data page.
8163 @end itemize
8164 @end deffn
8165
8166 @deffn {Command} {nand erase} num [offset length]
8167 @cindex NAND erasing
8168 @cindex NAND programming
8169 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
8170 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
8171 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
8172 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
8173 If those parameters are not specified,
8174 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
8175 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8176
8177 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
8178 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
8179 block marker.
8180 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
8181 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
8182 @end deffn
8183
8184 @deffn {Command} {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
8185 @cindex NAND writing
8186 @cindex NAND programming
8187 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
8188 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
8189 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
8190 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8191
8192 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
8193 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
8194
8195 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
8196 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
8197 past the end of the device.
8198 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
8199 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
8200 if that's being written.)
8201
8202 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
8203 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
8204 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
8205
8206 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
8207 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
8208 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
8209 @itemize @bullet
8210 @item no oob_* parameter
8211 @*File has only page data, which is written.
8212 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
8213 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
8214 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
8215 with hardware-computed ECC data.
8216 @item @code{oob_only}
8217 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
8218 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
8219 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
8220 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
8221 @item @code{oob_raw}
8222 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
8223 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
8224 un-altered OOB.
8225 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
8226 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
8227 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
8228 @item @code{oob_softecc}
8229 @*File has only page data, which is written.
8230 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
8231 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
8232 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
8233 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
8234 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
8235 @*File has only page data, which is written.
8236 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
8237 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
8238 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
8239 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
8240 @end itemize
8241 @end deffn
8242
8243 @deffn {Command} {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
8244 @cindex NAND verification
8245 @cindex NAND programming
8246 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
8247 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
8248 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8249
8250 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
8251 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
8252
8253 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
8254 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
8255 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
8256 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
8257 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
8258
8259 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
8260 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
8261 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
8262
8263 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
8264 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
8265 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
8266 be removed in a future release.
8267 @end deffn
8268
8269 @subsection Other NAND commands
8270 @cindex NAND other commands
8271
8272 @deffn {Command} {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
8273 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
8274 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
8275 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
8276 continues for @var{length} bytes.
8277 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
8278 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
8279 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8280
8281 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
8282 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
8283 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
8284 @end deffn
8285
8286 @deffn {Command} {nand info} num
8287 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8288 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
8289 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
8290 status for each block.
8291 @end deffn
8292
8293 @deffn {Command} {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8294 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
8295 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8296
8297 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
8298 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
8299 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
8300 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
8301 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
8302
8303 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
8304 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
8305 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
8306 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
8307 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
8308 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
8309 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
8310 @end deffn
8311
8312 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
8313 @subsection NAND Driver List
8314 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
8315 driver-specific options and behaviors.
8316 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
8317
8318 @deffn {NAND Driver} {at91sam9}
8319 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
8320 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
8321 address of the ECC controller.
8322 @example
8323 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
8324 @end example
8325 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
8326 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
8327 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
8328 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
8329 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
8330 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
8331 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
8332 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8333 @end deffn
8334 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
8335 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
8336 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8337 @end deffn
8338
8339 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
8340 properly configured for input or output.
8341 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
8342 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
8343 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8344 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8345 @end deffn
8346 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
8347 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
8348 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8349 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8350 @end deffn
8351 @end deffn
8352
8353 @deffn {NAND Driver} {davinci}
8354 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
8355 chips from Texas Instruments.
8356 It takes three extra parameters:
8357 address of the NAND chip;
8358 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
8359 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
8360 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
8361 @example
8362 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
8363 @end example
8364 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
8365 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
8366 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
8367 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
8368 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
8369 @end deffn
8370
8371 @deffn {NAND Driver} {lpc3180}
8372 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8373 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
8374 @deffn {Command} {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
8375 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
8376 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
8377 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8378 @end deffn
8379
8380 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
8381 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
8382 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
8383 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
8384 @end deffn
8385 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
8386
8387 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mx3}
8388 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
8389 should work for this chip as well.
8390 @end deffn
8391
8392 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mxc}
8393 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
8394 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
8395 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
8396 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
8397 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
8398 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
8399 @example
8400 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
8401 @end example
8402 @deffn {Command} {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
8403 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
8404 without parameter query status.
8405 @end deffn
8406 @end deffn
8407
8408 @deffn {NAND Driver} {orion}
8409 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8410 parameter: the address of the controller.
8411 @example
8412 nand device orion 0xd8000000
8413 @end example
8414 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
8415 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8416 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8417 change any behavior.
8418 @end deffn
8419
8420 @deffn {NAND Driver} {s3c2410}
8421 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2412}
8422 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2440}
8423 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2443}
8424 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c6400}
8425 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
8426 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
8427 specialized commands.
8428 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8429 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8430 change any behavior.
8431 @end deffn
8432
8433 @node Flash Programming
8434 @chapter Flash Programming
8435
8436 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
8437 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
8438 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
8439
8440 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
8441 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
8442
8443 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
8444 @enumerate
8445 @item 'init' is executed.
8446 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
8447 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
8448 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
8449 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
8450 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
8451 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
8452 @end enumerate
8453
8454 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
8455
8456 @example
8457 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
8458 # are optional parameters
8459 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8460 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
8461
8462 # binary files need the flash address passing
8463 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8464 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
8465 @end example
8466
8467 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
8468 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
8469 @cindex PLD
8470 @cindex FPGA
8471
8472 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
8473 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
8474 OpenOCD can support programming them.
8475 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
8476 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
8477 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
8478 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
8479
8480 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
8481
8482 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
8483 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
8484 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
8485
8486 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
8487 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
8488
8489 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
8490 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
8491 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
8492 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
8493 behavior.
8494 @end deffn
8495
8496 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
8497 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
8498 @end deffn
8499
8500 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
8501 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
8502 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
8503 @end deffn
8504
8505 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
8506
8507 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
8508 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
8509 that particular type of PLD.
8510
8511 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {virtex2} [no_jstart]
8512 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
8513 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
8514
8515 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
8516 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
8517 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
8518
8519 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
8520 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
8521 for FPGA @var{num}.
8522 @end deffn
8523 @end deffn
8524
8525 @node General Commands
8526 @chapter General Commands
8527 @cindex commands
8528
8529 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
8530 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
8531 commands are documented elsewhere.
8532
8533 Intent:
8534 @itemize @bullet
8535 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
8536 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
8537 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
8538 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
8539
8540 @item @b{From the human}
8541 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
8542 or via GDB (default port 3333).
8543
8544 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
8545 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
8546 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
8547
8548 @item @b{Machine Interface}
8549 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
8550 port is 5555.
8551 @end itemize
8552
8553
8554 @section Server Commands
8555
8556 @deffn {Command} {exit}
8557 Exits the current telnet session.
8558 @end deffn
8559
8560 @deffn {Command} {help} [string]
8561 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
8562 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
8563 Not every command provides helptext.
8564
8565 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
8566 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
8567 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
8568 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
8569 @end deffn
8570
8571 @deffn {Command} {usage} [string]
8572 With no parameters, prints usage text for all commands. Otherwise,
8573 prints all usage text of which command, help text, and usage text
8574 containing @var{string}.
8575 Not every command provides helptext.
8576 @end deffn
8577
8578 @deffn {Command} {sleep} msec [@option{busy}]
8579 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
8580 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
8581 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
8582 Useful in connection with script files
8583 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
8584 @end deffn
8585
8586 @deffn {Command} {shutdown} [@option{error}]
8587 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
8588 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
8589 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
8590
8591 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, the command @command{shutdown}
8592 will be automatically executed to cause OpenOCD to exit.
8593
8594 It is possible to specify, in the TCL list @var{pre_shutdown_commands} , a
8595 set of commands to be automatically executed before @command{shutdown} , e.g.:
8596 @example
8597 lappend pre_shutdown_commands @{echo "Goodbye, my friend ..."@}
8598 lappend pre_shutdown_commands @{echo "see you soon !"@}
8599 @end example
8600 The commands in the list will be executed (in the same order they occupy
8601 in the list) before OpenOCD exits. If one of the commands in the list
8602 fails, then the remaining commands are not executed anymore while OpenOCD
8603 will proceed to quit.
8604 @end deffn
8605
8606 @anchor{debuglevel}
8607 @deffn {Command} {debug_level} [n]
8608 @cindex message level
8609 Display debug level.
8610 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
8611 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
8612 Level 0 is error messages only;
8613 level 1 adds warnings;
8614 level 2 adds informational messages;
8615 level 3 adds debugging messages;
8616 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
8617 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
8618 the command line along with the location of that log
8619 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
8620 @xref{Running}.
8621 @end deffn
8622
8623 @deffn {Command} {echo} [-n] message
8624 Logs a message at "user" priority.
8625 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
8626 @example
8627 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
8628 @end example
8629 @end deffn
8630
8631 @deffn {Command} {log_output} [filename | "default"]
8632 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
8633 the default log output channel is stderr.
8634 @end deffn
8635
8636 @deffn {Command} {add_script_search_dir} [directory]
8637 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
8638 @end deffn
8639
8640 @deffn {Config Command} {bindto} [@var{name}]
8641 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
8642 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
8643 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
8644 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
8645 @end deffn
8646
8647 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
8648 @section Target State handling
8649 @cindex reset
8650 @cindex halt
8651 @cindex target initialization
8652
8653 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
8654 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
8655 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
8656 a current target which is used to perform the
8657 various operations. The current target may be changed
8658 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
8659 target which should become current.
8660
8661 @deffn {Command} {reg} [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
8662 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
8663 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
8664 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
8665 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
8666
8667 @emph{With no arguments}:
8668 list all available registers for the current target,
8669 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
8670 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
8671 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
8672 are flagged as such.
8673
8674 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
8675 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
8676 bypassing any internal cache.
8677
8678 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
8679 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
8680 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
8681 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
8682 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
8683 relevant module will flush such values.
8684
8685 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
8686 Debug and trace infrastructure:
8687
8688 @example
8689 > reg
8690 ===== ARM registers
8691 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
8692 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
8693 (2) r2 (/32)
8694 ...
8695 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
8696 >
8697 @end example
8698 @end deffn
8699
8700 @deffn {Command} {set_reg} dict
8701 Set register values of the target.
8702
8703 @itemize
8704 @item @var{dict} ... Tcl dictionary with pairs of register names and values.
8705 @end itemize
8706
8707 For example, the following command sets the value 0 to the program counter (pc)
8708 register and 0x1000 to the stack pointer (sp) register:
8709
8710 @example
8711 set_reg @{pc 0 sp 0x1000@}
8712 @end example
8713 @end deffn
8714
8715 @deffn {Command} {get_reg} [-force] list
8716 Get register values from the target and return them as Tcl dictionary with pairs
8717 of register names and values.
8718 If option "-force" is set, the register values are read directly from the
8719 target, bypassing any caching.
8720
8721 @itemize
8722 @item @var{list} ... List of register names
8723 @end itemize
8724
8725 For example, the following command retrieves the values from the program
8726 counter (pc) and stack pointer (sp) register:
8727
8728 @example
8729 get_reg @{pc sp@}
8730 @end example
8731 @end deffn
8732
8733 @deffn {Command} {write_memory} address width data ['phys']
8734 This function provides an efficient way to write to the target memory from a Tcl
8735 script.
8736
8737 @itemize
8738 @item @var{address} ... target memory address
8739 @item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
8740 @item @var{data} ... Tcl list with the elements to write
8741 @item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
8742 @end itemize
8743
8744 For example, the following command writes two 32 bit words into the target
8745 memory at address 0x20000000:
8746
8747 @example
8748 write_memory 0x20000000 32 @{0xdeadbeef 0x00230500@}
8749 @end example
8750 @end deffn
8751
8752 @deffn {Command} {read_memory} address width count ['phys']
8753 This function provides an efficient way to read the target memory from a Tcl
8754 script.
8755 A Tcl list containing the requested memory elements is returned by this function.
8756
8757 @itemize
8758 @item @var{address} ... target memory address
8759 @item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
8760 @item @var{count} ... number of elements to read
8761 @item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
8762 @end itemize
8763
8764 For example, the following command reads two 32 bit words from the target
8765 memory at address 0x20000000:
8766
8767 @example
8768 read_memory 0x20000000 32 2
8769 @end example
8770 @end deffn
8771
8772 @deffn {Command} {halt} [ms]
8773 @deffnx {Command} {wait_halt} [ms]
8774 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
8775 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
8776 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
8777 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
8778 (and enter debug mode).
8779 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
8780
8781 @quotation Warning
8782 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
8783 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
8784 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
8785 power mode by gating the core clock;
8786 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
8787
8788 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
8789 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
8790 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
8791 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
8792 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
8793 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
8794
8795 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
8796 work with a JTAG debugger.
8797 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
8798 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8799 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
8800 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
8801 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
8802 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
8803 @end quotation
8804
8805 @end deffn
8806
8807 @deffn {Command} {resume} [address]
8808 Resume the target at its current code position,
8809 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8810 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
8811 @end deffn
8812
8813 @deffn {Command} {step} [address]
8814 Single-step the target at its current code position,
8815 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8816 @end deffn
8817
8818 @anchor{resetcommand}
8819 @deffn {Command} {reset}
8820 @deffnx {Command} {reset run}
8821 @deffnx {Command} {reset halt}
8822 @deffnx {Command} {reset init}
8823 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
8824 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
8825 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
8826
8827 The optional parameter specifies what should
8828 happen after the reset.
8829 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
8830 The other options will not work on all systems.
8831 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8832
8833 @itemize @minus
8834 @item @b{run} Let the target run
8835 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
8836 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
8837 @end itemize
8838 @end deffn
8839
8840 @deffn {Command} {soft_reset_halt}
8841 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
8842 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
8843 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
8844 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
8845 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
8846 state.
8847 @end deffn
8848
8849 @deffn {Command} {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8850 @deffnx {Command} {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8851 Set values of reset signals.
8852 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
8853 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
8854 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
8855 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
8856
8857 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8858 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
8859 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8860 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8861 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
8862 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
8863 the signal will not be modified.
8864
8865 @quotation Note
8866 TRST is specially handled.
8867 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8868 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8869 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8870 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8871 instead of the TRST signal.
8872 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8873 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8874 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8875 with handlers for that event.
8876 @end quotation
8877 @end deffn
8878
8879 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8880 @section Memory access commands
8881 @cindex memory access
8882
8883 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8884 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8885 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8886 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8887
8888 @enumerate
8889 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8890 to change the current target.
8891 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8892 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8893 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8894 @end enumerate
8895
8896 @deffn {Command} {mdd} [phys] addr [count]
8897 @deffnx {Command} {mdw} [phys] addr [count]
8898 @deffnx {Command} {mdh} [phys] addr [count]
8899 @deffnx {Command} {mdb} [phys] addr [count]
8900 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8901 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8902 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8903 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8904 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8905 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8906 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8907 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8908 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8909 (If you want to process the data instead of displaying it,
8910 see the @code{read_memory} primitives.)
8911 @end deffn
8912
8913 @deffn {Command} {mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8914 @deffnx {Command} {mww} [phys] addr word [count]
8915 @deffnx {Command} {mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
8916 @deffnx {Command} {mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
8917 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8918 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8919 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8920 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8921 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8922 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8923 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8924 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8925 @end deffn
8926
8927 @anchor{imageaccess}
8928 @section Image loading commands
8929 @cindex image loading
8930 @cindex image dumping
8931
8932 @deffn {Command} {dump_image} filename address size
8933 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8934 binary file named @var{filename}.
8935 @end deffn
8936
8937 @deffn {Command} {fast_load}
8938 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8939 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8940 @end deffn
8941
8942 @deffn {Command} {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8943 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8944 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8945 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8946 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8947 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8948 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8949 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8950 separately.
8951 @end deffn
8952
8953 @deffn {Command} {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8954 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8955 The file format may optionally be specified
8956 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8957 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8958 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8959 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8960 @example
8961 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8962 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8963 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8964 load_image $fname [expr @{$address - $foffset@}] bin \
8965 $address $length
8966 @}
8967 @end example
8968 @end deffn
8969
8970 @deffn {Command} {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8971 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8972 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8973 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8974 The file format may optionally be specified
8975 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8976 @end deffn
8977
8978 @deffn {Command} {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8979 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8980 The file format may optionally be specified
8981 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8982 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8983 @end deffn
8984
8985 @deffn {Command} {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8986 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8987 The file format may optionally be specified
8988 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8989 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8990 @end deffn
8991
8992
8993 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8994 @cindex breakpoint
8995 @cindex watchpoint
8996
8997 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8998 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8999 watchpoints.
9000 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
9001
9002 @deffn {Command} {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
9003 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
9004 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
9005 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
9006 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
9007 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
9008
9009 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
9010 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
9011 @end deffn
9012
9013 @deffn {Command} {rbp} @option{all} | address
9014 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
9015 @end deffn
9016
9017 @deffn {Command} {rwp} address
9018 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
9019 @end deffn
9020
9021 @deffn {Command} {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
9022 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
9023 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
9024 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
9025 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
9026 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
9027 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
9028 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
9029 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
9030 @end deffn
9031
9032
9033 @section Real Time Transfer (RTT)
9034
9035 Real Time Transfer (RTT) is an interface specified by SEGGER based on basic
9036 memory reads and writes to transfer data bidirectionally between target and host.
9037 The specification is independent of the target architecture.
9038 Every target that supports so called "background memory access", which means
9039 that the target memory can be accessed by the debugger while the target is
9040 running, can be used.
9041 This interface is especially of interest for targets without
9042 Serial Wire Output (SWO), such as ARM Cortex-M0, or where semihosting is not
9043 applicable because of real-time constraints.
9044
9045 @quotation Note
9046 The current implementation supports only single target devices.
9047 @end quotation
9048
9049 The data transfer between host and target device is organized through
9050 unidirectional up/down-channels for target-to-host and host-to-target
9051 communication, respectively.
9052
9053 @quotation Note
9054 The current implementation does not respect channel buffer flags.
9055 They are used to determine what happens when writing to a full buffer, for
9056 example.
9057 @end quotation
9058
9059 Channels are exposed via raw TCP/IP connections. One or more RTT servers can be
9060 assigned to each channel to make them accessible to an unlimited number
9061 of TCP/IP connections.
9062
9063 @deffn {Command} {rtt setup} address size ID
9064 Configure RTT for the currently selected target.
9065 Once RTT is started, OpenOCD searches for a control block with the
9066 identifier @var{ID} starting at the memory address @var{address} within the next
9067 @var{size} bytes.
9068 @end deffn
9069
9070 @deffn {Command} {rtt start}
9071 Start RTT.
9072 If the control block location is not known, OpenOCD starts searching for it.
9073 @end deffn
9074
9075 @deffn {Command} {rtt stop}
9076 Stop RTT.
9077 @end deffn
9078
9079 @deffn {Command} {rtt polling_interval} [interval]
9080 Display the polling interval.
9081 If @var{interval} is provided, set the polling interval.
9082 The polling interval determines (in milliseconds) how often the up-channels are
9083 checked for new data.
9084 @end deffn
9085
9086 @deffn {Command} {rtt channels}
9087 Display a list of all channels and their properties.
9088 @end deffn
9089
9090 @deffn {Command} {rtt channellist}
9091 Return a list of all channels and their properties as Tcl list.
9092 The list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
9093 @end deffn
9094
9095 @deffn {Command} {rtt server start} port channel
9096 Start a TCP server on @var{port} for the channel @var{channel}.
9097 @end deffn
9098
9099 @deffn {Command} {rtt server stop} port
9100 Stop the TCP sever with port @var{port}.
9101 @end deffn
9102
9103 The following example shows how to setup RTT using the SEGGER RTT implementation
9104 on the target device.
9105
9106 @example
9107 resume
9108
9109 rtt setup 0x20000000 2048 "SEGGER RTT"
9110 rtt start
9111
9112 rtt server start 9090 0
9113 @end example
9114
9115 In this example, OpenOCD searches the control block with the ID "SEGGER RTT"
9116 starting at 0x20000000 for 2048 bytes. The RTT channel 0 is exposed through the
9117 TCP/IP port 9090.
9118
9119
9120 @section Misc Commands
9121
9122 @cindex profiling
9123 @deffn {Command} {profile} seconds filename [start end]
9124 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
9125 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
9126 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
9127 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
9128 limit the address range.
9129 @end deffn
9130
9131 @deffn {Command} {version}
9132 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
9133 @end deffn
9134
9135 @deffn {Command} {virt2phys} virtual_address
9136 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
9137 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
9138 @end deffn
9139
9140 @deffn {Command} {add_help_text} 'command_name' 'help-string'
9141 Add or replace help text on the given @var{command_name}.
9142 @end deffn
9143
9144 @deffn {Command} {add_usage_text} 'command_name' 'help-string'
9145 Add or replace usage text on the given @var{command_name}.
9146 @end deffn
9147
9148 @node Architecture and Core Commands
9149 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
9150 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
9151 @cindex Core Specific Commands
9152
9153 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
9154 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
9155 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
9156 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
9157
9158 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
9159 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
9160 @cindex tracing
9161 @cindex ETM
9162 @cindex ETB
9163
9164 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
9165 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
9166 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
9167
9168 @itemize
9169 @item
9170 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
9171 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
9172 supports such an interface.
9173 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
9174 and trace port support.)
9175 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
9176 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
9177 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
9178 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
9179 in the board-specific configuration file.
9180 @item
9181 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
9182 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
9183 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
9184 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
9185 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
9186 @end itemize
9187
9188 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
9189
9190 @quotation Issues
9191 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
9192 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
9193
9194 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
9195 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
9196 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
9197 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
9198 dummy trace port driver}.
9199
9200 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
9201 as well as tracing only during specific states
9202 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
9203
9204 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
9205 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
9206 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
9207 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
9208 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
9209
9210 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
9211 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
9212 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
9213 this original style of JTAG access.
9214 @end quotation
9215
9216 @subsection ETM Configuration
9217 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
9218
9219 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
9220 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
9221 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
9222
9223 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
9224 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
9225 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
9226 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
9227 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
9228 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
9229 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
9230 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
9231 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
9232
9233 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
9234 or @option{demultiplexed}.
9235 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
9236
9237 @quotation Warning
9238 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
9239 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
9240 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
9241 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
9242 @end quotation
9243
9244 @quotation Note
9245 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
9246 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
9247 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
9248 what CPU activities are traced.
9249 @end quotation
9250 @end deffn
9251
9252 @deffn {Command} {etm info}
9253 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
9254 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
9255 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
9256 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
9257 @end deffn
9258
9259 @deffn {Command} {etm status}
9260 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
9261 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
9262 Did trace data overflow?
9263 Was it triggered?
9264 @end deffn
9265
9266 @deffn {Command} {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
9267 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
9268 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
9269 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
9270 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
9271
9272 @itemize
9273 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
9274 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
9275 The value is one of
9276 @option{none} (save nothing),
9277 @option{data} (save data),
9278 @option{address} (save addresses),
9279 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
9280 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
9281 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
9282 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
9283 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
9284 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
9285 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
9286 trace stream without an image of the code.
9287 @end itemize
9288 @end deffn
9289
9290 @deffn {Command} {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9291 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
9292 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
9293 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
9294 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
9295
9296 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
9297 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
9298 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
9299 @end deffn
9300
9301 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
9302
9303 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
9304 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
9305 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
9306
9307 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
9308 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
9309 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
9310 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
9311 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
9312 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
9313 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
9314
9315 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
9316
9317 @itemize
9318 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
9319 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
9320 for instruction access within that function's body.
9321 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
9322 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
9323 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
9324 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
9325 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
9326 combining one of the above models with a counter.
9327 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
9328 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
9329 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
9330 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
9331 @item @emph{... more}
9332 @end itemize
9333
9334 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
9335 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
9336
9337 @deffn {Command} {etm analyze}
9338 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
9339 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
9340 @end deffn
9341
9342 @deffn {Command} {etm dump} filename
9343 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
9344 @end deffn
9345
9346 @deffn {Command} {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
9347 Opens an image file.
9348 @end deffn
9349
9350 @deffn {Command} {etm load} filename
9351 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
9352 @end deffn
9353
9354 @deffn {Command} {etm start}
9355 Starts trace data collection.
9356 @end deffn
9357
9358 @deffn {Command} {etm stop}
9359 Stops trace data collection.
9360 @end deffn
9361
9362 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
9363 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
9364
9365 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
9366
9367 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {dummy}
9368 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
9369 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
9370 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
9371 any trace data collection.}
9372 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
9373 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
9374 @end deffn
9375 @end deffn
9376
9377 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {etb}
9378 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
9379 to use on-chip ETB memory.
9380 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
9381 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
9382 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
9383 @end deffn
9384 @deffn {Command} {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
9385 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
9386 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
9387 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
9388 trace trigger becomes active.
9389
9390 @itemize
9391 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
9392 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
9393 afterwards.
9394 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
9395 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
9396 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
9397 what caused that event to happen.
9398 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
9399 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
9400 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
9401 how the event caused trouble.
9402 @end itemize
9403 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
9404 @end deffn
9405
9406 @end deffn
9407
9408 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
9409 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
9410 @cindex CTI
9411
9412 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
9413 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
9414 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
9415 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
9416 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
9417 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
9418
9419 @deffn {Command} {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-baseaddr} base_address
9420 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
9421 @var{apn}.
9422 On ADIv5 DAP @var{apn} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the CTI is connected to.
9423 On ADIv6 DAP @var{apn} is the base address of the DAP AP the CTI is connected to.
9424 The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
9425 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
9426 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
9427 including additional configuration.
9428 @end deffn
9429
9430 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
9431 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
9432 @end deffn
9433
9434 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name dump}
9435 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
9436 @end deffn
9437
9438 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name write} @var{reg_name} @var{value}
9439 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9440 @end deffn
9441
9442 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
9443 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9444 @end deffn
9445
9446 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
9447 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
9448 @end deffn
9449
9450 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
9451 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
9452 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
9453 @end deffn
9454
9455 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
9456 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
9457 of the CTI.
9458 @end deffn
9459
9460 @deffn {Command} {cti names}
9461 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
9462 useful in TCL scripting.
9463 @end deffn
9464
9465 @section Generic ARM
9466 @cindex ARM
9467
9468 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
9469 They are available in addition to other core-specific
9470 commands that may be available.
9471
9472 @deffn {Command} {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
9473 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
9474 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
9475 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
9476 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9477 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
9478 @end deffn
9479
9480 @deffn {Command} {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
9481 @cindex disassemble
9482 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9483 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9484 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
9485 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
9486 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
9487 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9488 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
9489
9490 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
9491 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
9492 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
9493 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
9494 with a handful of exceptions.
9495 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
9496 @end deffn
9497
9498 @deffn {Command} {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
9499 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
9500 passing parameters @var{CRn},
9501 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9502 and using the MCR instruction.
9503 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9504 an ARM register.)
9505 @end deffn
9506
9507 @deffn {Command} {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
9508 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
9509 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9510 and the MRC instruction.
9511 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
9512 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9513 an ARM register.)
9514 @end deffn
9515
9516 @deffn {Command} {arm reg}
9517 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
9518 core mode if necessary.
9519 @end deffn
9520
9521 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9522 @cindex ARM semihosting
9523 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
9524
9525 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
9526 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
9527 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
9528 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
9529 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
9530 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
9531 @end deffn
9532
9533 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_redirect} (@option{disable} | @option{tcp} <port>
9534 [@option{debug}|@option{stdio}|@option{all})
9535 @cindex ARM semihosting
9536 Redirect semihosting messages to a specified TCP port.
9537
9538 This command redirects debug (READC, WRITEC and WRITE0) and stdio (READ, WRITE)
9539 semihosting operations to the specified TCP port.
9540 The command allows to select which type of operations to redirect (debug, stdio, all (default)).
9541 Note: for stdio operations, only I/O from/to ':tt' file descriptors are redirected.
9542 @end deffn
9543
9544 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9545 @cindex ARM semihosting
9546 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
9547
9548 @example
9549 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
9550 @end example
9551
9552 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
9553 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
9554 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
9555 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
9556 @end deffn
9557
9558 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9559 @cindex ARM semihosting
9560 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
9561 status.
9562
9563 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
9564 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
9565 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
9566 debugger.
9567 @end deffn
9568
9569 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9570 @cindex ARM semihosting
9571 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
9572
9573 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
9574 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
9575 the value returned by the target.
9576
9577 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
9578 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
9579 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
9580 encountering a break.
9581
9582 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
9583 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
9584 to the debugger.
9585 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
9586 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
9587 request or equivalent").
9588
9589 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
9590 this option (default: disabled).
9591 @end deffn
9592
9593 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_read_user_param}
9594 @cindex ARM semihosting
9595 Read parameter of the semihosting call from the target. Usable in
9596 semihosting-user-cmd-0x10* event handlers, returning a string.
9597
9598 When the target makes semihosting call with operation number from range 0x100-
9599 0x107, an optional string parameter can be passed to the server. This parameter
9600 is valid during the run of the event handlers and is accessible with this
9601 command.
9602 @end deffn
9603
9604 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_basedir} [dir]
9605 @cindex ARM semihosting
9606 Set the base directory for semihosting I/O, either an absolute path or a path relative to OpenOCD working directory.
9607 Use "." for the current directory.
9608 @end deffn
9609
9610 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
9611 @cindex ARMv4
9612 @cindex ARMv5
9613
9614 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
9615 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
9616 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
9617 variant.
9618
9619 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
9620 @cindex ARM7
9621 @cindex ARM9
9622
9623 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
9624 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
9625 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
9626 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
9627
9628 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9629 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
9630 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
9631 instead of breakpoints.
9632 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9633
9634 This should be
9635 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
9636 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
9637 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
9638 @end deffn
9639
9640 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9641 @cindex DCC
9642 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
9643 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
9644 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9645
9646 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
9647 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
9648 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
9649 @end deffn
9650
9651 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9652 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
9653 that don't check completion of the operation.
9654 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9655
9656 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
9657 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
9658 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
9659 @end deffn
9660
9661 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
9662 @cindex ARM9
9663
9664 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
9665 integer processors.
9666 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
9667
9668 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
9669 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
9670 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
9671 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
9672
9673 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
9674 @deffn {Command} {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9675 @cindex vector_catch
9676 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
9677 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
9678 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
9679 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
9680 to those hardware vectors.
9681
9682 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
9683 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
9684 vector catch hardware to intercept
9685 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
9686 @option{none} of them,
9687 or a list with one or more of the following:
9688 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
9689 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
9690 @end deffn
9691
9692 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
9693 @cindex ARM920T
9694
9695 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
9696 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
9697 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
9698 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9699 and ARM9 commands.
9700
9701 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cache_info}
9702 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
9703 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
9704 @end deffn
9705
9706 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
9707 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9708 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9709 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
9710 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
9711 (Not all registers can be written.)
9712 @end deffn
9713
9714 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_cache} filename
9715 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
9716 @end deffn
9717
9718 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_mmu} filename
9719 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
9720 @end deffn
9721
9722 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
9723 @cindex ARM926ej-s
9724
9725 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
9726 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
9727 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
9728 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9729 and ARM9 commands.
9730
9731 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
9732 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
9733
9734 @deffn {Command} {arm926ejs cache_info}
9735 Print information about the caches found.
9736 @end deffn
9737
9738 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
9739 @cindex ARM966E
9740
9741 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
9742 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9743 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9744 and ARM9 commands.
9745
9746 @deffn {Command} {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
9747 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9748 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9749 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
9750 ARM966E-S TRM.
9751 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
9752 as required for BIST support.
9753 @end deffn
9754
9755 @subsection XScale specific commands
9756 @cindex XScale
9757
9758 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
9759
9760 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
9761 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
9762 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
9763 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
9764 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
9765 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
9766 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
9767
9768 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
9769 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
9770 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
9771 the mini-IC.
9772
9773 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
9774 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
9775 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
9776 code layout in memory:
9777 @example
9778 _vectors:
9779 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9780 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9781 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9782 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9783 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9784 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9785 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9786 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9787 .org 0x100
9788 .long real_reset_vector
9789 .long real_ui_handler
9790 .long real_swi_handler
9791 .long real_pf_abort
9792 .long real_data_abort
9793 .long 0 /* unused */
9794 .long real_irq_handler
9795 .long real_fiq_handler
9796 @end example
9797
9798 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
9799 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
9800 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
9801 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
9802 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
9803 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
9804 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
9805 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
9806 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
9807 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
9808 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
9809 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
9810 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
9811 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
9812 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
9813 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
9814 software.
9815
9816 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
9817 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
9818 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
9819 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
9820
9821 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
9822 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
9823 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
9824 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
9825 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
9826 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
9827 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
9828 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
9829 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
9830
9831 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
9832 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9833
9834 @deffn {Command} {xscale analyze_trace}
9835 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
9836 @end deffn
9837
9838 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_clean_address} address
9839 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
9840 @end deffn
9841
9842 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_info}
9843 Displays information about the CPU caches.
9844 @end deffn
9845
9846 @deffn {Command} {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
9847 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9848 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9849 @end deffn
9850
9851 @deffn {Command} {xscale debug_handler} target address
9852 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
9853 @end deffn
9854
9855 @deffn {Command} {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9856 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
9857 @end deffn
9858
9859 @deffn {Command} {xscale dump_trace} filename
9860 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
9861 @end deffn
9862
9863 @deffn {Command} {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9864 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
9865 @end deffn
9866
9867 @deffn {Command} {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9868 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
9869 @end deffn
9870
9871 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
9872 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
9873 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
9874 and modifying how it is emptied.
9875 @end deffn
9876
9877 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
9878 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
9879 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
9880 The image @var{type} may be one of
9881 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
9882 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
9883 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
9884 @end deffn
9885
9886 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
9887 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
9888 @cindex vector_catch
9889 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
9890 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
9891
9892 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
9893 @example
9894 0x01 Trap Reset
9895 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
9896 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
9897 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
9898 0x10 Trap Data Abort
9899 0x20 reserved
9900 0x40 Trap IRQ
9901 0x80 Trap FIQ
9902 @end example
9903 @end deffn
9904
9905 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
9906 @cindex vector_table
9907
9908 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
9909 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
9910 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
9911 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
9912 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
9913
9914 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
9915
9916 @end deffn
9917
9918 @section ARMv6 Architecture
9919 @cindex ARMv6
9920
9921 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
9922 @cindex ARM11
9923
9924 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9925 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9926 which is enabled by default.
9927 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9928 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9929 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9930 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9931 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9932 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9933 @end deffn
9934
9935 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9936 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9937 which is enabled by default.
9938 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9939 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9940 @end deffn
9941
9942 @deffn {Command} {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9943 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9944 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9945 they are disabled by default.
9946 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9947 @end deffn
9948
9949 @deffn {Command} {arm11 vcr} [value]
9950 @cindex vector_catch
9951 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9952 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9953 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9954
9955 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9956 for certain hardware events.
9957 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9958 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9959 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9960 @end deffn
9961
9962 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9963 @cindex ARMv7
9964 @cindex ARMv8
9965
9966 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9967 @cindex Cortex-A
9968
9969 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a cache_info}
9970 display information about target caches
9971 @end deffn
9972
9973 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dacrfixup} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9974 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9975 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9976 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9977 Defaults to 'off'.
9978 @end deffn
9979
9980 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dbginit}
9981 Initialize core debug
9982 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9983 @end deffn
9984
9985 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9986 Display/set the current SMP mode
9987 @end deffn
9988
9989 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9990 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9991 @end deffn
9992
9993 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9994 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9995 @end deffn
9996
9997 @deffn {Command} {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9998 configure l2x cache
9999 @end deffn
10000
10001 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
10002 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
10003 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
10004 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
10005 possible (4096) entries are printed.
10006 @end deffn
10007
10008 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
10009 @cindex Cortex-R
10010
10011 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 dbginit}
10012 Initialize core debug
10013 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
10014 @end deffn
10015
10016 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
10017 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
10018 @end deffn
10019
10020
10021 @subsection ARM CoreSight TPIU and SWO specific commands
10022 @cindex tracing
10023 @cindex SWO
10024 @cindex SWV
10025 @cindex TPIU
10026
10027 ARM CoreSight provides several modules to generate debugging
10028 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
10029 through TPIU or SWO modules to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
10030 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
10031
10032 ARM CoreSight provides independent HW blocks named TPIU and SWO each with its
10033 own functionality. Embedded in Cortex-M3 and M4, ARM provides an optional HW
10034 block that includes both TPIU and SWO functionalities and is again named TPIU,
10035 which causes quite some confusion.
10036 The registers map of all the TPIU and SWO implementations allows using a single
10037 driver that detects at runtime the features available.
10038
10039 The @command{tpiu} is used for either TPIU or SWO.
10040 A convenient alias @command{swo} is available to help distinguish, in scripts,
10041 the commands for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
10042
10043 @deffn {Command} {swo} ...
10044 Alias of @command{tpiu ...}. Can be used in scripts to distinguish the commands
10045 for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
10046 @end deffn
10047
10048 @deffn {Command} {tpiu create} tpiu_name configparams...
10049 Creates a TPIU or a SWO object. The two commands are equivalent.
10050 Add the object in a list and add new commands (@command{@var{tpiu_name}})
10051 which are used for various purposes including additional configuration.
10052
10053 @itemize @bullet
10054 @item @var{tpiu_name} -- the name of the TPIU or SWO object.
10055 This name is also used to create the object's command, referred to here
10056 as @command{$tpiu_name}, and in other places where the TPIU or SWO needs to be identified.
10057 @item @var{configparams} -- all parameters accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} are permitted.
10058
10059 You @emph{must} set here the AP and MEM_AP base_address through @code{-dap @var{dap_name}},
10060 @code{-ap-num @var{ap_number}} and @code{-baseaddr @var{base_address}}.
10061 @end itemize
10062 @end deffn
10063
10064 @deffn {Command} {tpiu names}
10065 Lists all the TPIU or SWO objects created so far. The two commands are equivalent.
10066 @end deffn
10067
10068 @deffn {Command} {tpiu init}
10069 Initialize all registered TPIU and SWO. The two commands are equivalent.
10070 These commands are used internally during initialization. They can be issued
10071 at any time after the initialization, too.
10072 @end deffn
10073
10074 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name cget} queryparm
10075 Each configuration parameter accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} can be
10076 individually queried, to return its current value.
10077 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name accepted by that command, such as @code{-dap}.
10078 @end deffn
10079
10080 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name configure} configparams...
10081 The options accepted by this command may also be specified as parameters
10082 to @command{tpiu create}. Their values can later be queried one at a time by
10083 using the @command{$tpiu_name cget} command.
10084
10085 @itemize @bullet
10086 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access this
10087 TPIU. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to create and manage DAP instances.
10088
10089 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- sets DAP access port for TPIU.
10090 On ADIv5 DAP @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
10091 On ADIv6 DAP @var{ap_number} is the base address of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
10092
10093 @item @code{-baseaddr} @var{base_address} -- sets the TPIU @var{base_address} where
10094 to access the TPIU in the DAP AP memory space.
10095
10096 @item @code{-protocol} (@option{sync}|@option{uart}|@option{manchester}) -- sets the
10097 protocol used for trace data:
10098 @itemize @minus
10099 @item @option{sync} -- synchronous parallel trace output mode, using @var{port_width}
10100 data bits (default);
10101 @item @option{uart} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as regular UART 8N1) coding;
10102 @item @option{manchester} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester coding.
10103 @end itemize
10104
10105 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} -- assigns an event handler,
10106 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered. The events
10107 @code{pre-enable}, @code{post-enable}, @code{pre-disable} and @code{post-disable}
10108 are defined for TPIU/SWO.
10109 A typical use case for the event @code{pre-enable} is to enable the trace clock
10110 of the TPIU.
10111
10112 @item @code{-output} (@option{external}|@option{:}@var{port}|@var{filename}|@option{-}) -- specifies
10113 the destination of the trace data:
10114 @itemize @minus
10115 @item @option{external} -- configure TPIU/SWO to let user capture trace
10116 output externally, either with an additional UART or with a logic analyzer (default);
10117 @item @option{-} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather trace data
10118 and forward it to @command{tcl_trace} command;
10119 @item @option{:}@var{port} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather
10120 trace data, open a TCP server at port @var{port} and send the trace data to
10121 each connected client;
10122 @item @var{filename} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to
10123 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename}, which can be
10124 either a regular file or a named pipe.
10125 @end itemize
10126
10127 @item @code{-traceclk} @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} -- mandatory parameter.
10128 Specifies the frequency in Hz of the trace clock. For the TPIU embedded in
10129 Cortex-M3 or M4, this is usually the same frequency as HCLK. For protocol
10130 @option{sync} this is twice the frequency of the pin data rate.
10131
10132 @item @code{-pin-freq} @var{trace_freq} -- specifies the expected data rate
10133 in Hz of the SWO pin. Parameter used only on protocols @option{uart} and
10134 @option{manchester}. Can be omitted to let the adapter driver select the
10135 maximum supported rate automatically.
10136
10137 @item @code{-port-width} @var{port_width} -- sets to @var{port_width} the width
10138 of the synchronous parallel port used for trace output. Parameter used only on
10139 protocol @option{sync}. If not specified, default value is @var{1}.
10140
10141 @item @code{-formatter} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- specifies if the formatter
10142 should be enabled. Parameter used only on protocol @option{sync}. If not specified,
10143 default value is @var{0}.
10144 @end itemize
10145 @end deffn
10146
10147 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name enable}
10148 Uses the parameters specified by the previous @command{$tpiu_name configure}
10149 to configure and enable the TPIU or the SWO.
10150 If required, the adapter is also configured and enabled to receive the trace
10151 data.
10152 This command can be used before @command{init}, but it will take effect only
10153 after the @command{init}.
10154 @end deffn
10155
10156 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name disable}
10157 Disable the TPIU or the SWO, terminating the receiving of the trace data.
10158 @end deffn
10159
10160
10161
10162 Example usage:
10163 @enumerate
10164 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
10165 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
10166 enough to:
10167 @example
10168 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
10169 ...
10170 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
10171 ...
10172 @end example
10173 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
10174 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
10175 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
10176 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
10177 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
10178 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
10179 @example
10180 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
10181 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
10182 @end example
10183 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
10184 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
10185 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
10186 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
10187 @example
10188 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
10189 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
10190 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
10191 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -protocol uart" \
10192 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -traceclk 24000000 -pin-freq 12000000" \
10193 -c "stm32l1.tpiu enable"
10194 @end example
10195 @end enumerate
10196
10197 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
10198 @cindex tracing
10199 @cindex SWO
10200 @cindex SWV
10201 @cindex ITM
10202 @cindex ETM
10203
10204 @deffn {Command} {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
10205 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
10206 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
10207 @end deffn
10208
10209 @deffn {Command} {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
10210 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
10211 @end deffn
10212
10213 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
10214 @cindex Cortex-M
10215
10216 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
10217 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
10218
10219 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
10220 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
10221 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
10222 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
10223 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
10224 the step command leaves with the core running.
10225
10226 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
10227 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
10228 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
10229 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
10230
10231 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
10232 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
10233 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
10234 does.
10235
10236 Default is @option{auto}.
10237 @end deffn
10238
10239 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
10240 @cindex vector_catch
10241 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
10242 for certain hardware events.
10243
10244 Parameters request interception of
10245 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
10246 @option{none} of them,
10247 or one or more of the following:
10248 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
10249 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
10250 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
10251 @option{irq_err},
10252 @option{state_err},
10253 @option{chk_err}, or
10254 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
10255 @option{reset}.
10256 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
10257 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
10258 are mapped to HardFault.
10259 UsageFault checks for
10260 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
10261 must also be explicitly enabled.
10262
10263 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
10264 @end deffn
10265
10266 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
10267 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
10268 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
10269
10270 @itemize @minus
10271 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
10272 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
10273 @end itemize
10274
10275 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
10276 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
10277 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
10278 to manually reset the peripherals.
10279 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
10280
10281 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
10282 instead.
10283 @end deffn
10284
10285 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
10286 @cindex ARMv8-A
10287 @cindex aarch64
10288
10289 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 cache_info}
10290 Display information about target caches
10291 @end deffn
10292
10293 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 dbginit}
10294 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
10295 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
10296 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
10297 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
10298 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
10299 @end deffn
10300
10301 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
10302 @cindex disassemble
10303 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
10304 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
10305 @end deffn
10306
10307 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
10308 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
10309 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
10310 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
10311 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
10312 @end deffn
10313
10314 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
10315 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
10316 @option{on}.
10317 @end deffn
10318
10319 @deffn {Command} {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
10320 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
10321 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
10322 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
10323 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
10324 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
10325 @end deffn
10326
10327 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
10328
10329 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
10330 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
10331
10332 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
10333
10334 @deffn {Command} {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
10335 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
10336 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
10337 @end deffn
10338
10339 @deffn {Command} {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
10340 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
10341 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
10342 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
10343 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
10344 @end deffn
10345
10346 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
10347
10348 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flush_caches}
10349 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
10350 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
10351 @end deffn
10352
10353 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
10354
10355 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
10356 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
10357 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
10358 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
10359 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
10360 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
10361 can be collected.
10362
10363 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
10364 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
10365 tooling.
10366
10367 @quotation Issues
10368 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
10369 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
10370 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
10371 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
10372
10373 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
10374 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
10375 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
10376 software operation on the CPU.
10377 @end quotation
10378
10379 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
10380 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
10381 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
10382 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
10383 @end deffn
10384
10385 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace fifo} address
10386 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
10387 @end deffn
10388
10389 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10390 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
10391 control is disabled.
10392 @end deffn
10393
10394 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
10395 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
10396 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
10397 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
10398
10399 Supported trace formats:
10400 @itemize
10401 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
10402 timing to be determined.
10403 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
10404 addresses.
10405 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
10406 @end itemize
10407 @end deffn
10408
10409 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
10410 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
10411 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
10412 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
10413
10414 Supported conditions:
10415 @itemize
10416 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
10417 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
10418 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
10419 instruction matches start data and mask.
10420 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
10421 instruction matches start data and mask.
10422 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
10423 data and mask.
10424 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
10425 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
10426 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
10427 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
10428 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
10429 @end itemize
10430 @end deffn
10431
10432 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
10433 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
10434 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
10435 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
10436
10437 Supported conditions:
10438 @itemize
10439 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
10440 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
10441 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
10442 instruction matches stop data and mask.
10443 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
10444 instruction matches stop data and mask.
10445 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
10446 data and mask.
10447 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
10448 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
10449 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
10450 @end itemize
10451 @end deffn
10452
10453 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
10454 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
10455
10456 Supported triggers:
10457 @itemize
10458 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
10459 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
10460 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
10461 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
10462 collection.
10463 @end itemize
10464 @end deffn
10465
10466 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
10467
10468 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace init}
10469 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
10470 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
10471 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
10472 @end deffn
10473
10474 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace info}
10475 Display trace configuration.
10476 @end deffn
10477
10478 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace status}
10479 Display trace collection status.
10480 @end deffn
10481
10482 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace start}
10483 Start manual trace collection.
10484 @end deffn
10485
10486 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace stop}
10487 Stop manual trace collection.
10488 @end deffn
10489
10490 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
10491 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
10492 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
10493 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10494 @option{size} options using DMA.
10495 @end deffn
10496
10497 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
10498 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
10499 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
10500 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10501 @option{size} options using DMA.
10502 @end deffn
10503
10504 @section Intel Architecture
10505
10506 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
10507 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
10508 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
10509 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
10510 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
10511 @itemize
10512 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
10513 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
10514 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
10515 @end itemize
10516
10517 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
10518 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
10519 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
10520
10521 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idw} address
10522 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10523 @end deffn
10524
10525 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idh} address
10526 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10527 @end deffn
10528
10529 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idb} address
10530 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10531 @end deffn
10532
10533 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iww} address
10534 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10535 @end deffn
10536
10537 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwh} address
10538 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10539 @end deffn
10540
10541 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwb} address
10542 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10543 @end deffn
10544
10545 @section OpenRISC Architecture
10546
10547 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
10548 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
10549
10550 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
10551 @deffn {Command} {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
10552 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
10553 @end deffn
10554 @deffn {Command} {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
10555 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
10556
10557 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
10558
10559 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
10560 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
10561 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
10562 @end deffn
10563
10564 @subsection Registers commands
10565 @deffn {Command} {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
10566 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
10567 included in the generated target descriptor file.
10568
10569 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
10570
10571 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
10572 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
10573 and "timer" groups.
10574
10575 @emph{example:}
10576 @example
10577 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
10578 @end example
10579
10580 @end deffn
10581
10582 @section RISC-V Architecture
10583
10584 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
10585 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
10586 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
10587 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
10588 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
10589 implement version 0.11.
10590
10591 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
10592
10593 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
10594 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
10595 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
10596
10597 @subsection Vector Registers
10598
10599 For harts that implement the vector extension, OpenOCD provides access to the
10600 relevant CSRs, as well as the vector registers (v0-v31). The size of each
10601 vector register is dependent on the value of vlenb. RISC-V allows each vector
10602 register to be divided into selected-width elements, and this division can be
10603 changed at run-time. Because OpenOCD cannot update register definitions at
10604 run-time, it exposes each vector register to gdb as a union of fields of
10605 vectors so that users can easily access individual bytes, shorts, words,
10606 longs, and quads inside each vector register. It is left to gdb or
10607 higher-level debuggers to present this data in a more intuitive format.
10608
10609 In the XML register description, the vector registers (when vlenb=16) look as
10610 follows:
10611
10612 @example
10613 <feature name="org.gnu.gdb.riscv.vector">
10614 <vector id="bytes" type="uint8" count="16"/>
10615 <vector id="shorts" type="uint16" count="8"/>
10616 <vector id="words" type="uint32" count="4"/>
10617 <vector id="longs" type="uint64" count="2"/>
10618 <vector id="quads" type="uint128" count="1"/>
10619 <union id="riscv_vector">
10620 <field name="b" type="bytes"/>
10621 <field name="s" type="shorts"/>
10622 <field name="w" type="words"/>
10623 <field name="l" type="longs"/>
10624 <field name="q" type="quads"/>
10625 </union>
10626 <reg name="v0" bitsize="128" regnum="4162" save-restore="no"
10627 type="riscv_vector" group="vector"/>
10628 ...
10629 <reg name="v31" bitsize="128" regnum="4193" save-restore="no"
10630 type="riscv_vector" group="vector"/>
10631 </feature>
10632 @end example
10633
10634 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
10635
10636 @deffn {Config Command} {riscv expose_csrs} n[-m|=name] [...]
10637 Configure which CSRs to expose in addition to the standard ones. The CSRs to expose
10638 can be specified as individual register numbers or register ranges (inclusive). For the
10639 individually listed CSRs, a human-readable name can optionally be set using the @code{n=name}
10640 syntax, which will get @code{csr_} prepended to it. If no name is provided, the register will be
10641 named @code{csr<n>}.
10642
10643 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
10644 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
10645 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or if the target implements custom
10646 CSRs.
10647
10648 @example
10649 # Expose a single RISC-V CSR number 128 under the name "csr128":
10650 $_TARGETNAME expose_csrs 128
10651
10652 # Expose multiple RISC-V CSRs 128..132 under names "csr128" through "csr132":
10653 $_TARGETNAME expose_csrs 128-132
10654
10655 # Expose a single RISC-V CSR number 1996 under custom name "csr_myregister":
10656 $_TARGETNAME expose_csrs 1996=myregister
10657 @end example
10658 @end deffn
10659
10660 @deffn {Config Command} {riscv expose_custom} n[-m|=name] [...]
10661 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
10662 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
10663 configures individual registers or register ranges (inclusive) that shall be exposed.
10664 Number 0 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
10665 For individually listed registers, a human-readable name can be optionally provided
10666 using the @code{n=name} syntax, which will get @code{custom_} prepended to it. If no
10667 name is provided, the register will be named @code{custom<n>}.
10668
10669 @example
10670 # Expose one RISC-V custom register with number 0xc010 (0xc000 + 16)
10671 # under the name "custom16":
10672 $_TARGETNAME expose_custom 16
10673
10674 # Expose a range of RISC-V custom registers with numbers 0xc010 .. 0xc018
10675 # (0xc000+16 .. 0xc000+24) under the names "custom16" through "custom24":
10676 $_TARGETNAME expose_custom 16-24
10677
10678 # Expose one RISC-V custom register with number 0xc020 (0xc000 + 32) under
10679 # user-defined name "custom_myregister":
10680 $_TARGETNAME expose_custom 32=myregister
10681 @end example
10682 @end deffn
10683
10684 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10685 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
10686 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
10687 @end deffn
10688
10689 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10690 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
10691 deasserted.
10692 @end deffn
10693
10694 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
10695 Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
10696 This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
10697 @end deffn
10698
10699 @deffn Command {riscv set_mem_access} method1 [method2] [method3]
10700 Specify which RISC-V memory access method(s) shall be used, and in which order
10701 of priority. At least one method must be specified.
10702
10703 Available methods are:
10704 @itemize
10705 @item @code{progbuf} - Use RISC-V Debug Program Buffer to access memory.
10706 @item @code{sysbus} - Access memory via RISC-V Debug System Bus interface.
10707 @item @code{abstract} - Access memory via RISC-V Debug abstract commands.
10708 @end itemize
10709
10710 By default, all memory access methods are enabled in the following order:
10711 @code{progbuf sysbus abstract}.
10712
10713 This command can be used to change the memory access methods if the default
10714 behavior is not suitable for a particular target.
10715 @end deffn
10716
10717 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virtual} on|off
10718 When on, memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory depending
10719 on the current system configuration. When off (default), all memory accessses are performed
10720 on physical memory.
10721 @end deffn
10722
10723 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virt2phys} on|off
10724 When on (default), memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory
10725 depending on the current satp configuration. When off, all memory accessses are
10726 performed on physical memory.
10727 @end deffn
10728
10729 @deffn {Command} {riscv resume_order} normal|reversed
10730 Some software assumes all harts are executing nearly continuously. Such
10731 software may be sensitive to the order that harts are resumed in. On harts
10732 that don't support hasel, this option allows the user to choose the order the
10733 harts are resumed in. If you are using this option, it's probably masking a
10734 race condition problem in your code.
10735
10736 Normal order is from lowest hart index to highest. This is the default
10737 behavior. Reversed order is from highest hart index to lowest.
10738 @end deffn
10739
10740 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
10741 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
10742 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
10743 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
10744 values.
10745
10746 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
10747 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
10748 and DBUS registers, respectively.
10749 @end deffn
10750
10751 @deffn {Command} {riscv use_bscan_tunnel} value
10752 Enable or disable use of a BSCAN tunnel to reach DM. Supply the width of
10753 the DM transport TAP's instruction register to enable. Supply a value of 0 to disable.
10754 @end deffn
10755
10756 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreakm} on|off
10757 Control dcsr.ebreakm. When on (default), M-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10758 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10759 @end deffn
10760
10761 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaks} on|off
10762 Control dcsr.ebreaks. When on (default), S-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10763 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10764 @end deffn
10765
10766 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaku} on|off
10767 Control dcsr.ebreaku. When on (default), U-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10768 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10769 @end deffn
10770
10771 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
10772
10773 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
10774 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
10775 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
10776 @example
10777 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
10778 riscv authdata_write [expr @{$challenge + 1@}]
10779 @end example
10780
10781 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_read}
10782 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
10783 @end deffn
10784
10785 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_write} value
10786 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
10787 @end deffn
10788
10789 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
10790
10791 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
10792 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
10793
10794 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_read} address
10795 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
10796 @end deffn
10797
10798 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_write} address value
10799 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
10800 @end deffn
10801
10802 @section ARC Architecture
10803 @cindex ARC
10804
10805 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
10806 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
10807 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
10808 at: @url{http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx}.
10809 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
10810 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
10811 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
10812 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
10813 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
10814 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
10815 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
10816 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
10817 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
10818 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
10819 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
10820
10821
10822 @subsection General ARC commands
10823
10824 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
10825
10826 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
10827 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
10828 arguments:
10829
10830 @itemize @bullet
10831
10832 @item @code{-name} name
10833 @*Name of a register.
10834
10835 @item @code{-num} number
10836 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
10837
10838 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
10839 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
10840
10841 @end itemize
10842
10843 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
10844
10845 @itemize @bullet
10846
10847 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
10848 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
10849 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
10850 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
10851 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
10852 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
10853
10854 @item @code{-core}
10855 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
10856 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
10857 spaces.
10858
10859 @item @code{-bcr}
10860 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
10861 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
10862 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
10863 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
10864 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
10865
10866 @item @code{-type} type_name
10867 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
10868 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
10869
10870 @item @code{-g}
10871 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
10872 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
10873 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
10874 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
10875 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
10876
10877 @end itemize
10878
10879 @end deffn
10880
10881 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
10882 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
10883 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
10884 @end deffn
10885
10886 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
10887 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
10888 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
10889 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
10890 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
10891 startbit endbit}.
10892 @end deffn
10893
10894 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
10895 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
10896 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct}. command definition.
10897 @end deffn
10898
10899 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
10900 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
10901 as an argument for a single command invocation.
10902 @end deffn
10903
10904 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
10905
10906 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
10907 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
10908 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10909 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10910
10911 @end deffn
10912
10913 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
10914 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
10915 registers.
10916 @end deffn
10917
10918 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
10919 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
10920 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10921 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10922
10923 @end deffn
10924
10925 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
10926 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
10927 registers.
10928 @end deffn
10929
10930 @section STM8 Architecture
10931 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
10932 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
10933
10934 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
10935 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
10936
10937 @section Xtensa Architecture
10938 Xtensa processors are based on a modular, highly flexible 32-bit RISC architecture
10939 that can easily scale from a tiny, cache-less controller or task engine to a high-performance
10940 SIMD/VLIW DSP provided by Cadence.
10941 @url{https://www.cadence.com/en_US/home/tools/ip/tensilica-ip/tensilica-xtensa-controllers-and-extensible-processors.html}.
10942
10943 OpenOCD supports generic Xtensa processors implementation which can be customized by
10944 simply providing vendor-specific core configuration which controls every configurable
10945 Xtensa architecture option, e.g. number of address registers, exceptions, reduced
10946 size instructions support, memory banks configuration etc. Also OpenOCD supports SMP
10947 configurations for Xtensa processors with any number of cores and allows to configure
10948 their debug signals interconnection (so-called "break/stall networks") which control how
10949 debug signals are distributed among cores. Xtensa "break networks" are compatible with
10950 ARM's Cross Trigger Interface (CTI). For debugging code on Xtensa chips OpenOCD
10951 uses JTAG protocol. Currently OpenOCD implements several Epsressif Xtensa-based chips of
10952 @uref{https://www.espressif.com/en/products/socs, ESP32 family}.
10953
10954 @subsection General Xtensa Commands
10955
10956 @deffn {Command} {xtensa set_permissive} (0|1)
10957 By default accessing memory beyond defined regions is forbidden. This commnd controls memory access address check.
10958 When set to (1), skips access controls and address range check before read/write memory.
10959 @end deffn
10960
10961 @deffn {Command} {xtensa maskisr} (on|off)
10962 Selects whether interrupts will be disabled during stepping over single instruction. The default configuration is (off).
10963 @end deffn
10964
10965 @deffn {Command} {xtensa smpbreak} [none|breakinout|runstall] | [BreakIn] [BreakOut] [RunStallIn] [DebugModeOut]
10966 Configures debug signals connection ("break network") for currently selected core.
10967 @itemize @bullet
10968 @item @code{none} - Core's "break/stall network" is disconnected. Core is not affected by any debug
10969 signal from other cores.
10970 @item @code{breakinout} - Core's "break network" is fully connected (break inputs and outputs are enabled).
10971 Core will receive debug break signals from other cores and send such signals to them. For example when another core
10972 is stopped due to breakpoint hit this core will be stopped too and vice versa.
10973 @item @code{runstall} - Core's "stall network" is fully connected (stall inputs and outputs are enabled).
10974 This feature is not well implemented and tested yet.
10975 @item @code{BreakIn} - Core's "break-in" signal is enabled.
10976 Core will receive debug break signals from other cores. For example when another core is
10977 stopped due to breakpoint hit this core will be stopped too.
10978 @item @code{BreakOut} - Core's "break-out" signal is enabled.
10979 Core will send debug break signal to other cores. For example when this core is
10980 stopped due to breakpoint hit other cores with enabled break-in signals will be stopped too.
10981 @item @code{RunStallIn} - Core's "runstall-in" signal is enabled.
10982 This feature is not well implemented and tested yet.
10983 @item @code{DebugModeOut} - Core's "debugmode-out" signal is enabled.
10984 This feature is not well implemented and tested yet.
10985 @end itemize
10986 @end deffn
10987
10988 @deffn {Command} {xtensa perfmon_enable} <counter_id> <select> [mask] [kernelcnt] [tracelevel]
10989 Enable and start performance counter.
10990 @itemize @bullet
10991 @item @code{counter_id} - Counter ID (0-1).
10992 @item @code{select} - Selects performance metric to be counted by the counter,
10993 e.g. 0 - CPU cycles, 2 - retired instructions.
10994 @item @code{mask} - Selects input subsets to be counted (counter will
10995 increment only once even if more than one condition corresponding to a mask bit occurs).
10996 @item @code{kernelcnt} - 0 - count events with "CINTLEVEL <= tracelevel",
10997 1 - count events with "CINTLEVEL > tracelevel".
10998 @item @code{tracelevel} - Compares this value to "CINTLEVEL" when deciding
10999 whether to count.
11000 @end itemize
11001 @end deffn
11002
11003 @deffn {Command} {xtensa perfmon_dump} (counter_id)
11004 Dump performance counter value. If no argument specified, dumps all counters.
11005 @end deffn
11006
11007 @deffn {Command} {xtensa tracestart} [pc <pcval>/[<maskbitcount>]] [after <n> [ins|words]]
11008 Set up and start a HW trace. Optionally set PC address range to trigger tracing stop when reached during program execution.
11009 This command also allows to specify the amount of data to capture after stop trigger activation.
11010 @itemize @bullet
11011 @item @code{pcval} - PC value which will trigger trace data collection stop.
11012 @item @code{maskbitcount} - PC value mask.
11013 @item @code{n} - Maximum number of instructions/words to capture after trace stop trigger.
11014 @end itemize
11015 @end deffn
11016
11017 @deffn {Command} {xtensa tracestop}
11018 Stop current trace as started by the tracestart command.
11019 @end deffn
11020
11021 @deffn {Command} {xtensa tracedump} <outfile>
11022 Dump trace memory to a file.
11023 @end deffn
11024
11025 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
11026 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
11027 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
11028 @cindex tracing
11029 @cindex libdcc
11030 @cindex DCC
11031 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
11032 the target uses appropriate libraries.
11033 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
11034 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
11035
11036 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
11037 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
11038 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
11039 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
11040 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
11041 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
11042
11043 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
11044 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
11045 arrays of various size integers from the target,
11046 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
11047 The target being debugged may
11048 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
11049 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
11050 each supported by a command:
11051
11052 @itemize
11053 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
11054 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
11055 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
11056 finding out how some fault was triggered.
11057
11058 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
11059 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
11060 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
11061
11062 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
11063 and then displayed at any time.
11064 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
11065
11066 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
11067 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
11068 @end itemize
11069
11070 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
11071 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
11072 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
11073 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
11074 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
11075 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
11076 does the same thing.
11077
11078 @deffn {Command} {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
11079 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
11080 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
11081 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
11082 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
11083
11084 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
11085 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
11086 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
11087 @end deffn
11088
11089 @deffn {Command} {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
11090 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
11091 in the order they triggered.
11092 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
11093 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
11094 history records.
11095 @end deffn
11096
11097 @deffn {Command} {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
11098 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
11099 they have been triggered.
11100 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
11101 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
11102 and associates it with that identifier.
11103
11104 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
11105 are not related except by this command.
11106 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
11107 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
11108 @end deffn
11109
11110
11111 @node JTAG Commands
11112 @chapter JTAG Commands
11113 @cindex JTAG Commands
11114 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
11115 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
11116 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
11117 may be needed to work with targets which require special
11118 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
11119
11120 To use these commands you will need to understand some
11121 of the basics of JTAG, including:
11122
11123 @itemize @bullet
11124 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
11125 devices such as a CPUs.
11126 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
11127 standard state machine (in parallel)
11128 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
11129 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
11130 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
11131 while the reading previous ones.
11132 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
11133 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
11134 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
11135 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
11136 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
11137 registers.
11138 @end itemize
11139
11140 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
11141
11142 These commands are used by developers who need to access
11143 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
11144 the order of TAP state transitions.
11145 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
11146 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
11147 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
11148 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
11149 these commands are not available.
11150
11151 @deffn {Command} {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
11152 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
11153 that specify the entire register.
11154 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
11155 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
11156 The return value holds the original value of each
11157 of those fields.
11158
11159 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
11160 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
11161 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
11162 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
11163 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
11164
11165 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
11166 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
11167
11168 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
11169 in that state.
11170 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
11171 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
11172 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
11173
11174 @quotation Warning
11175 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
11176 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
11177 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
11178 data registers, which may have different lengths.
11179 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
11180 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
11181 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
11182 (by connecting a different scan chain).
11183 @end quotation
11184 @end deffn
11185
11186 @deffn {Command} {flush_count}
11187 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
11188 This may be used for performance tuning.
11189
11190 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
11191 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
11192 not change with the amount of data which is written.
11193 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
11194 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
11195 instead of batching them into larger operations.
11196 @end deffn
11197
11198 @deffn {Command} {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
11199 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
11200 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
11201 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
11202 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
11203 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
11204
11205 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
11206 in that state.
11207 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
11208 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
11209 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
11210
11211 @quotation Note
11212 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
11213 register values, unlike data register values.
11214 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
11215 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
11216 @end quotation
11217 @end deffn
11218
11219 @deffn {Command} {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
11220 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
11221 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
11222 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
11223 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
11224 Then, in a series of single state transitions
11225 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
11226 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
11227 The final state must also be stable.
11228 @end deffn
11229
11230 @deffn {Command} {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
11231 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
11232 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
11233 Instructions often need some time
11234 to execute before they take effect.
11235 @end deffn
11236
11237 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
11238 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
11239
11240 @deffn {Command} {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
11241 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
11242 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
11243 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
11244 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
11245 @end deffn
11246
11247 @deffn {Command} {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
11248 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
11249 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
11250 must also be enabled.
11251 Default is enabled.
11252 @end deffn
11253
11254 @section TAP state names
11255 @cindex TAP state names
11256
11257 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
11258 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
11259 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
11260 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
11261
11262 @itemize @bullet
11263 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
11264 acts as if TRST were pulsed
11265 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
11266 @item @b{DRSELECT}
11267 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
11268 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
11269 through the data register
11270 @item @b{DREXIT1}
11271 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
11272 for update or more shifting
11273 @item @b{DREXIT2}
11274 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
11275 @item @b{IRSELECT}
11276 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
11277 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
11278 through the instruction register
11279 @item @b{IREXIT1}
11280 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
11281 for update or more shifting
11282 @item @b{IREXIT2}
11283 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
11284 @end itemize
11285
11286 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
11287 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
11288 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
11289 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
11290
11291 @itemize @bullet
11292 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
11293 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
11294 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
11295 may not be as expected.
11296 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
11297 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
11298 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
11299 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
11300 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
11301 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
11302 @end itemize
11303
11304 @node Boundary Scan Commands
11305 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
11306
11307 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
11308 boundary scan based hardware testing.
11309 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
11310 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
11311
11312 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
11313 @cindex Serial Vector Format
11314 @cindex SVF
11315
11316 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
11317 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
11318 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
11319 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
11320
11321 @deffn {Command} {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
11322 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
11323 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
11324 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
11325
11326 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
11327 affect their semantics.
11328
11329 Command options:
11330 @itemize @minus
11331 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
11332 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
11333 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
11334 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
11335 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
11336 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
11337 on the real interface;
11338 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
11339 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
11340 errors.
11341 @end itemize
11342 @end deffn
11343
11344 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
11345 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
11346 @cindex XSVF
11347
11348 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
11349 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
11350 Xilinx devices.
11351 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
11352 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
11353
11354 @quotation Important
11355 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
11356 @end quotation
11357
11358 @deffn {Command} {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
11359 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
11360 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
11361 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
11362 that TAP.
11363 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
11364 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
11365 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
11366 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
11367 @end deffn
11368
11369 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
11370 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
11371 after building the software.
11372 You may find them useful:
11373
11374 @itemize
11375 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
11376 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
11377 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
11378 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
11379 @end itemize
11380
11381 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
11382 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
11383 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
11384 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
11385 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
11386 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
11387 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
11388
11389
11390 @section IPDBG: JTAG-Host server
11391 @cindex IPDBG JTAG-Host server
11392 @cindex IPDBG
11393
11394 IPDBG is a set of tools to debug IP-Cores. It comprises, among others, a logic analyzer and an arbitrary
11395 waveform generator. These are synthesize-able hardware descriptions of
11396 logic circuits in addition to software for control, visualization and further analysis.
11397 In a session using JTAG for its transport protocol, OpenOCD supports the function
11398 of a JTAG-Host. The JTAG-Host is needed to connect the circuit over JTAG to the
11399 control-software. For more details see @url{http://ipdbg.org}.
11400
11401 @deffn {Command} {ipdbg} [@option{-start|-stop}] @option{-tap @var{tapname}} @option{-hub @var{ir_value} [@var{dr_length}]} [@option{-port @var{number}}] [@option{-tool @var{number}}] [@option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]}]
11402 Starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server. Arguments can be specified in any order.
11403
11404 Command options:
11405 @itemize @bullet
11406 @item @option{-start|-stop} starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server (default: start).
11407 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} targeting the TAP @var{tapname}.
11408 @item @option{-hub @var{ir_value}} states that the JTAG hub is
11409 reachable with dr-scans while the JTAG instruction register has the value @var{ir_value}.
11410 @item @option{-port @var{number}} tcp port number where the JTAG-Host is listening.
11411 @item @option{-tool @var{number}} number of the tool/feature. These corresponds to the ports "data_(up/down)_(0..6)" at the JtagHub.
11412 @item @option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]} On some devices, the user data-register is only reachable if there is a
11413 specific value in a second dr. This second dr is called vir (virtual ir). With this parameter given, the IPDBG satisfies this condition prior an
11414 access to the IPDBG-Hub. The value shifted into the vir is given by the first parameter @var{vir_value} (default: 0x11). The second
11415 parameter @var{length} is the length of the vir data register (default: 5). With the @var{instr_code} (default: 0x00e) parameter the ir value to
11416 shift data through vir can be configured.
11417 @end itemize
11418 @end deffn
11419
11420 Examples:
11421 @example
11422 ipdbg -start -tap xc6s.tap -hub 0x02 -port 4242 -tool 4
11423 @end example
11424 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 4242 which connects to tool 4.
11425 The connection is through the TAP of a Xilinx Spartan 6 on USER1 instruction (tested with a papillion pro board).
11426
11427 @example
11428 ipdbg -start -tap 10m50.tap -hub 0x00C -vir -port 60000 -tool 1
11429 @end example
11430 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 60000 which connects to tool 1 (data_up_1/data_down_1).
11431 The connection is through the TAP of a Intel MAX10 virtual jtag component (sld_instance_index is 0; sld_ir_width is smaller than 5).
11432
11433 @node Utility Commands
11434 @chapter Utility Commands
11435 @cindex Utility Commands
11436
11437 @section RAM testing
11438 @cindex RAM testing
11439
11440 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
11441 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
11442 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
11443 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
11444 hardware problems.
11445
11446 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
11447 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
11448 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
11449 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
11450
11451 Load the memory testing functions with
11452
11453 @example
11454 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
11455 @end example
11456
11457 to get access to the following facilities:
11458
11459 @deffn {Command} {memTestDataBus} address
11460 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
11461 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
11462 @end deffn
11463
11464 @deffn {Command} {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
11465 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
11466 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
11467 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
11468 @end deffn
11469
11470 @deffn {Command} {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
11471 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
11472 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
11473 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
11474 @end deffn
11475
11476 @deffn {Command} {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
11477 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
11478 @end deffn
11479
11480 @section Firmware recovery helpers
11481 @cindex Firmware recovery
11482
11483 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
11484 devices recovery with JTAG.
11485
11486 For quickstart instructions run:
11487 @example
11488 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
11489 @end example
11490
11491 @node GDB and OpenOCD
11492 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
11493 @cindex GDB
11494 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
11495 to debug remote targets.
11496 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
11497
11498 @itemize
11499 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
11500 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
11501 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
11502 as shown in this chapter.
11503 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
11504 that also will probably need to be configured.
11505 @end itemize
11506
11507 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
11508 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
11509 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
11510 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
11511 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
11512 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
11513
11514 @section Connecting to GDB
11515 @cindex Connecting to GDB
11516 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
11517 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
11518 errors, which has since been fixed; see
11519 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
11520
11521 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
11522
11523 @enumerate
11524 @item
11525 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
11526 @example
11527 target extended-remote localhost:3333
11528 @end example
11529 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
11530
11531 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
11532 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
11533 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
11534
11535 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
11536 remote command above that becomes:
11537 @example
11538 tar ext :3333
11539 @end example
11540
11541 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
11542 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
11543 available through the command:
11544 @example
11545 target remote localhost:3333
11546 @end example
11547
11548 @item
11549 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
11550 @example
11551 target extended-remote | \
11552 openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
11553 @end example
11554 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
11555 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
11556 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
11557 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
11558 @end enumerate
11559
11560 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
11561 GDB command line.
11562
11563 @section Sample GDB session startup
11564
11565 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
11566 than they do when you're debugging locally.
11567 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
11568 small ARM program.
11569 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
11570 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
11571
11572 @example
11573 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
11574 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
11575 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
11576 ...
11577 (gdb) monitor reset halt
11578 ...
11579 (gdb) load
11580 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
11581 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
11582 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
11583 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
11584 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
11585 (gdb) continue
11586 Continuing.
11587 ...
11588 @end example
11589
11590 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
11591 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
11592 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
11593 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
11594
11595 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
11596
11597 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
11598 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
11599 packet size and the device's memory map.
11600 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
11601 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
11602 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
11603
11604 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
11605 You may need to set those up by hand.
11606 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
11607 something like:
11608
11609 @example
11610 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
11611 @end example
11612
11613 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
11614
11615 @example
11616 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
11617 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
11618 @end example
11619
11620 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
11621 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
11622 do not have such restrictions.
11623
11624 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
11625 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
11626 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
11627 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
11628
11629 @section Programming using GDB
11630 @cindex Programming using GDB
11631 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
11632
11633 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
11634 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
11635 @example
11636 gdb_memory_map disable
11637 @end example
11638 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
11639 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
11640 working area.
11641
11642 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
11643 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
11644 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
11645 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
11646
11647 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
11648 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
11649
11650 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
11651 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
11652 @example
11653 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
11654 @end example
11655
11656 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
11657 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
11658
11659 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
11660 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
11661 will be used.
11662
11663 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
11664 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
11665 @example
11666 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
11667 @end example
11668 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
11669
11670 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
11671 can be used.
11672
11673 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11674 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11675 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
11676
11677 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
11678 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
11679 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
11680
11681 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
11682 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
11683 and GDB treats it as it were running.
11684 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
11685 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
11686 without any intrusion of the target process.
11687
11688 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
11689 Place following command after target configuration:
11690 @example
11691 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
11692 @end example
11693
11694 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
11695 switch off gdb_memory_map:
11696 @example
11697 gdb_memory_map disable
11698 @end example
11699
11700 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
11701 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
11702 @example
11703 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
11704 @end example
11705
11706 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
11707 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
11708
11709 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
11710 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
11711 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
11712 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
11713
11714 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
11715 previously shown variables.
11716
11717 It's also possible to connect more than one GDB to the same target by the
11718 target's configuration option @code{-gdb-max-connections}. This allows, for
11719 example, one GDB to run a script that continuously polls a set of variables
11720 while other GDB can be used interactively. Be extremely careful in this case,
11721 because the two GDB can easily get out-of-sync.
11722
11723 @section RTOS Support
11724 @cindex RTOS Support
11725 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
11726
11727 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
11728 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
11729
11730 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
11731 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
11732 GDB commands.
11733
11734 @* An example setup is below:
11735
11736 @example
11737 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
11738 @end example
11739
11740 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
11741
11742 Currently supported rtos's include:
11743 @itemize @bullet
11744 @item @option{eCos}
11745 @item @option{ThreadX}
11746 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
11747 @item @option{linux}
11748 @item @option{ChibiOS}
11749 @item @option{embKernel}
11750 @item @option{mqx}
11751 @item @option{uCOS-III}
11752 @item @option{nuttx}
11753 @item @option{RIOT}
11754 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
11755 @item @option{Zephyr}
11756 @end itemize
11757
11758 At any time, it's possible to drop the selected RTOS using:
11759 @example
11760 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos none
11761 @end example
11762
11763 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
11764 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
11765
11766 @table @code
11767 @item eCos symbols
11768 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
11769 @item ThreadX symbols
11770 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
11771 @item FreeRTOS symbols
11772 @raggedright
11773 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
11774 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
11775 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
11776 @end raggedright
11777 @item linux symbols
11778 init_task.
11779 @item ChibiOS symbols
11780 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
11781 @item embKernel symbols
11782 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
11783 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
11784 @item mqx symbols
11785 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
11786 @item uC/OS-III symbols
11787 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty.
11788 @item nuttx symbols
11789 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable.
11790 @item RIOT symbols
11791 @raggedright
11792 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads,
11793 _tcb_name_offset.
11794 @end raggedright
11795 @item Zephyr symbols
11796 _kernel, _kernel_openocd_offsets, _kernel_openocd_size_t_size
11797 @end table
11798
11799 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
11800 some, eg. FreeRTOS, uC/OS-III and Zephyr, extra steps must be taken.
11801
11802 Zephyr must be compiled with the DEBUG_THREAD_INFO option. This will generate some symbols
11803 with information needed in order to build the list of threads.
11804
11805 FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
11806 along with the project:
11807
11808 @table @code
11809 @item FreeRTOS
11810 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
11811 @item uC/OS-III
11812 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
11813 @end table
11814
11815 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
11816 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
11817 @cindex SMP
11818 @cindex RTOS
11819 @cindex hwthread
11820 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
11821 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
11822 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
11823 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
11824 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
11825 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
11826 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
11827 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
11828 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
11829
11830 @node Tcl Scripting API
11831 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
11832 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
11833 @cindex Tcl scripts
11834 @section API rules
11835
11836 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
11837 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
11838 of state information as an argument to each proc.
11839
11840 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
11841 pair list and lists.
11842
11843 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
11844 list.
11845
11846 @example
11847 > set foo(me) Duane
11848 > set foo(you) Oyvind
11849 > set foo(mouse) Micky
11850 > set foo(duck) Donald
11851 @end example
11852
11853 If one does this:
11854
11855 @example
11856 > set foo
11857 @end example
11858
11859 The result is:
11860
11861 @example
11862 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
11863 @end example
11864
11865 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
11866
11867 @verbatim
11868 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
11869 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
11870 }
11871 @end verbatim
11872
11873 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
11874 should be passed in to the proc in question.
11875
11876 @section Internal low-level Commands
11877
11878 By "low-level", we mean commands that a human would typically not
11879 invoke directly.
11880
11881 @itemize
11882 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
11883
11884 Return information about the flash banks
11885
11886 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
11887
11888 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
11889 its execution. Example:
11890
11891 @example
11892 > capture "reset init"
11893 @end example
11894
11895 @end itemize
11896
11897 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
11898 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
11899 called "flash_banks".
11900
11901 @section Tcl RPC server
11902 @cindex RPC
11903
11904 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
11905 commands and receive the results.
11906
11907 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
11908 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
11909 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
11910 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
11911 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
11912
11913 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
11914 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
11915 @command{capture} command.
11916
11917 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
11918
11919 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
11920 @cindex RPC Notifications
11921
11922 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11923 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11924
11925 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
11926 in the following format.
11927
11928 @verbatim
11929 type target_event event [event-name]
11930 type target_state state [state-name]
11931 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
11932 @end verbatim
11933
11934 @deffn {Command} {tcl_notifications} [on/off]
11935 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
11936 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11937 Defaults to off.
11938
11939 @end deffn
11940
11941 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
11942 @cindex RPC trace output
11943
11944 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11945 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11946
11947 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
11948
11949 @verbatim
11950 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
11951 @end verbatim
11952
11953 @deffn {Command} {tcl_trace} [on/off]
11954 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
11955 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11956 Defaults to off.
11957
11958 See an example application here:
11959 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
11960
11961 @end deffn
11962
11963 @node FAQ
11964 @chapter FAQ
11965 @cindex faq
11966 @enumerate
11967 @anchor{faqrtck}
11968 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
11969 @cindex RTCK
11970 @cindex adaptive clocking
11971 @*
11972
11973 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
11974 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
11975 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
11976 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
11977
11978 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
11979 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
11980 for example. There are 2 basic options:
11981 @enumerate
11982 @item
11983 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
11984 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
11985 @item
11986 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
11987 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
11988 @end enumerate
11989
11990 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
11991 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
11992 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
11993 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
11994 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
11995 power).
11996
11997 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
11998 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
11999 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
12000 ARM926 scenario).
12001 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
12002 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
12003 JTAG can use a faster clock.
12004
12005 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
12006 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
12007 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
12008 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
12009
12010 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
12011
12012 In order to make use of this,
12013 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
12014 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
12015
12016 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
12017 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
12018 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
12019 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
12020 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
12021
12022 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
12023 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
12024 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
12025 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
12026
12027 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
12028 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
12029 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
12030 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
12031 with a CPLD.
12032 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
12033 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
12034 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
12035 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
12036 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
12037 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
12038
12039 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
12040
12041 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
12042
12043 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
12044 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
12045 depending on the chips on your board.
12046 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
12047 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
12048 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
12049
12050 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
12051 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
12052 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
12053
12054 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
12055 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
12056 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
12057 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
12058
12059 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
12060 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
12061 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
12062 this way.
12063
12064 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
12065 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
12066 clock rate.
12067 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
12068 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
12069 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
12070
12071 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
12072
12073 @example
12074 # Example: 1.234MHz
12075 adapter speed 1234
12076 @end example
12077
12078
12079 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
12080
12081 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
12082 around Windows filenames.
12083
12084 @example
12085 > echo \a
12086
12087 > echo @{\a@}
12088 \a
12089 > echo "\a"
12090
12091 >
12092 @end example
12093
12094
12095 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
12096
12097 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
12098 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
12099 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
12100
12101 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
12102 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
12103 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
12104
12105 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
12106 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
12107 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
12108
12109 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
12110
12111 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
12112 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
12113 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
12114 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
12115
12116 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
12117 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
12118 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
12119
12120 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
12121 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
12122
12123 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
12124 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
12125 memory read caused data abort".
12126
12127 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
12128 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
12129 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
12130 be done, feel free to add this here.
12131
12132 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
12133 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
12134 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
12135 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
12136 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
12137 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
12138 gracefully stops.
12139
12140 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
12141 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
12142 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
12143
12144 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
12145 often do not @b{in the interest of saving memory} waste these few
12146 bytes. Painful...
12147
12148
12149 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
12150 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
12151
12152 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
12153 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
12154 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
12155 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
12156 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
12157 reset, everything else should work fine.
12158
12159 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
12160 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
12161 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
12162 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
12163
12164 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
12165 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
12166 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
12167 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
12168
12169 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
12170
12171 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
12172 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
12173 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
12174
12175 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
12176 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
12177
12178 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
12179 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
12180 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
12181 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
12182 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
12183 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
12184 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
12185 clock frequency?
12186
12187 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
12188 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
12189 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
12190 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
12191 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
12192
12193 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
12194
12195 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
12196 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
12197 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
12198 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
12199 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
12200 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
12201 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
12202
12203 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
12204
12205 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
12206 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
12207 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
12208 up DRAM and loading it with code.
12209
12210 @anchor{faqtaporder}
12211 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
12212 particular order?
12213
12214 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
12215 the same order used by the hardware.
12216
12217 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
12218 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
12219 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
12220 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
12221 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
12222 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
12223
12224 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
12225 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
12226 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
12227 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
12228
12229 @itemize @bullet
12230 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
12231 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
12232 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
12233 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
12234 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
12235 @end itemize
12236
12237 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
12238
12239 @itemize @bullet
12240 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
12241 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
12242 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
12243 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
12244 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
12245 @end itemize
12246
12247
12248 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
12249 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
12250 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
12251
12252 TODO.
12253
12254 @end enumerate
12255
12256 @node Tcl Crash Course
12257 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
12258 @cindex Tcl
12259
12260 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
12261 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
12262 how the Tcl scripts work.
12263
12264 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
12265 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
12266 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
12267 OpenOCD.
12268
12269 @section Tcl Rule #1
12270 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
12271 @enumerate
12272 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
12273 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
12274 @end enumerate
12275
12276 The Tcl equal is this:
12277
12278 @enumerate
12279 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
12280 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
12281 @end enumerate
12282
12283 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
12284 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
12285
12286 @section Tcl Rule #1b
12287 There is a second pair of rules.
12288 @enumerate
12289 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
12290 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
12291 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
12292 in Tcl.
12293 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
12294 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
12295 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
12296 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
12297 @end enumerate
12298
12299 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
12300 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
12301 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
12302 Everything is a string}
12303
12304 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
12305 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
12306 difference is subtle.
12307 @enumerate
12308 @item Parse Time
12309 @item Evaluation Time
12310 @end enumerate
12311
12312 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
12313 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
12314 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
12315
12316 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
12317 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
12318 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
12319 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
12320
12321 @itemize @bullet
12322 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
12323 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
12324 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
12325 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
12326 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
12327 @example
12328 # bash example
12329 X=`date`
12330 echo "The Date is: $X"
12331 # Tcl example
12332 set X [date]
12333 puts "The Date is: $X"
12334 @end example
12335 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
12336 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
12337 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
12338 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
12339 is a string}
12340 @example
12341 set x "Dinner"
12342 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
12343 @end example
12344 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
12345 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
12346 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
12347 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
12348 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
12349 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
12350 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
12351 @end itemize
12352
12353 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
12354
12355 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
12356
12357 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
12358
12359 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
12360 the normal way.
12361
12362 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
12363 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
12364 line is immediately executed.
12365
12366 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
12367 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
12368
12369 @subsection Command Execution
12370
12371 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
12372 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
12373 control flow operators.
12374
12375 Commands are executed like this:
12376
12377 @enumerate
12378 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
12379 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
12380 @item Repeat until End Of File.
12381 @end enumerate
12382
12383 It sort of works like this:
12384 @example
12385 for(;;)@{
12386 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
12387
12388 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
12389
12390 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
12391 @}
12392 @end example
12393
12394 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
12395 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
12396 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
12397 of the function. Note the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
12398 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
12399 ``LookupCommand()''
12400
12401 @subsection The FOR command
12402
12403 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
12404 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
12405 command just like any other command.
12406
12407 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
12408 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
12409 are:
12410
12411 @enumerate 0
12412 @item The ascii text 'for'
12413 @item The start text
12414 @item The test expression
12415 @item The next text
12416 @item The body text
12417 @end enumerate
12418
12419 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
12420 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
12421 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
12422 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
12423
12424 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
12425 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
12426
12427 @example
12428 int
12429 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
12430 int *argc,
12431 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
12432 @end example
12433
12434 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
12435 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
12436 still operates in the same basic way.
12437
12438 @subsection FOR command implementation
12439
12440 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
12441 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
12442
12443 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
12444
12445 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
12446
12447 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
12448 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
12449 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
12450
12451 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
12452 expression and returns a value.
12453
12454 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
12455 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
12456 @example
12457 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
12458
12459 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
12460
12461 int
12462 MyForCommand( void *interp,
12463 int argc,
12464 char **argv )
12465 @{
12466 if( argc != 5 )@{
12467 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
12468 return ERROR;
12469 @}
12470
12471 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
12472
12473 // Execute the start statement.
12474 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
12475
12476 // Top of loop test
12477 for(;;)@{
12478 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
12479 if( i == 0 )
12480 break;
12481
12482 // Execute the body
12483 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
12484
12485 // Execute the LOOP part
12486 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
12487 @}
12488
12489 // Return no error
12490 SetResult( interp, "" );
12491 return SUCCESS;
12492 @}
12493 @end example
12494
12495 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
12496 in the same basic way.
12497
12498 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
12499
12500 @subsection source and find commands
12501 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
12502 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
12503 @*Remember the parsing rules
12504 @enumerate
12505 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
12506 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
12507 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
12508 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
12509 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
12510 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
12511 That character begins Tcl comments.)
12512 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
12513 it reads a file and executes as a script.
12514 @end enumerate
12515 @subsection format command
12516 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
12517 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
12518 @b{sprintf()}.
12519 @b{Example}
12520 @example
12521 set x 6
12522 set y 7
12523 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr @{$x * $y@}]]
12524 @end example
12525 @enumerate
12526 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
12527 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
12528 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
12529 @* Refer to Rule #1
12530 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
12531 @* Refer to Rule #1.
12532 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
12533 @end enumerate
12534 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
12535 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
12536 @example
12537 #1 Good
12538 proc someproc @{@} @{
12539 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
12540 @}
12541 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
12542 #2 Good - no variables
12543 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
12544 #3 Good Curly Braces
12545 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
12546 puts "Time: [date]"
12547 @}
12548 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
12549 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
12550 @end example
12551 @enumerate
12552 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
12553 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
12554 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
12555 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
12556 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
12557 command.
12558 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
12559 @*There are 4 examples:
12560 @enumerate
12561 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
12562 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
12563 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
12564 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
12565 @end enumerate
12566
12567 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
12568 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
12569 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
12570
12571 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
12572 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
12573 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
12574 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
12575 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
12576 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
12577 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
12578 @end enumerate
12579 @subsection Global Variables
12580 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
12581 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
12582 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
12583 @example
12584 proc myproc @{ @} @{
12585 set y 0 #Local variable Y
12586 global x #Global variable X
12587 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
12588 @}
12589 @end example
12590 @section Other Tcl Hacks
12591 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
12592 @example
12593 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
12594 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr @{$x + 1@}]@} @{
12595 # Create var name
12596 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
12597 # Make it a global
12598 global $vn
12599 # Set it.
12600 set $vn [expr @{1 << $x@}]
12601 @}
12602 @end example
12603 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
12604 @example
12605 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
12606 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
12607 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
12608 @}
12609 @end example
12610
12611 @node License
12612 @appendix The GNU Free Documentation License.
12613 @include fdl.texi
12614
12615 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
12616 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
12617 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
12618 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
12619 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
12620 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
12621
12622 @printindex cp
12623
12624 @node Command and Driver Index
12625 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
12626 @printindex fn
12627
12628 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)